7371 lines
289 KiB
Plaintext
7371 lines
289 KiB
Plaintext
This is libc.info, produced by makeinfo version 5.1 from libc.texinfo.
|
||
|
||
This is ‘The GNU C Library Reference Manual’, for version 2.33 (GNU).
|
||
|
||
Copyright © 1993–2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||
|
||
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
|
||
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
|
||
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
|
||
Invariant Sections being “Free Software Needs Free Documentation” and
|
||
“GNU Lesser General Public License”, the Front-Cover texts being “A GNU
|
||
Manual”, and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
|
||
license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation
|
||
License".
|
||
|
||
(a) The FSF’s Back-Cover Text is: “You have the freedom to copy and
|
||
modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
|
||
developing GNU and promoting software freedom.”
|
||
INFO-DIR-SECTION Software libraries
|
||
START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
|
||
* Libc: (libc). C library.
|
||
END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
|
||
|
||
INFO-DIR-SECTION GNU C library functions and macros
|
||
START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
|
||
* ALTWERASE: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ARGP_ERR_UNKNOWN: (libc)Argp Parser Functions.
|
||
* ARG_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* BC_BASE_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* BC_DIM_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* BC_SCALE_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* BC_STRING_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* BRKINT: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* BUFSIZ: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* CCTS_OFLOW: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CHAR_BIT: (libc)Width of Type.
|
||
* CHILD_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* CIGNORE: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CLK_TCK: (libc)Processor Time.
|
||
* CLOCAL: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CLOCKS_PER_SEC: (libc)CPU Time.
|
||
* CLOCK_MONOTONIC: (libc)Getting the Time.
|
||
* CLOCK_REALTIME: (libc)Getting the Time.
|
||
* COLL_WEIGHTS_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* CPU_CLR: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* CPU_FEATURE_USABLE: (libc)X86.
|
||
* CPU_ISSET: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* CPU_SET: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* CPU_SETSIZE: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* CPU_ZERO: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* CREAD: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CRTS_IFLOW: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CS5: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CS6: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CS7: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CS8: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CSIZE: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* CSTOPB: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* DTTOIF: (libc)Directory Entries.
|
||
* E2BIG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EACCES: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EADDRINUSE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EADDRNOTAVAIL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EADV: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EAFNOSUPPORT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EAGAIN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EALREADY: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EAUTH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBACKGROUND: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADF: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADFD: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADMSG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADR: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADRPC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADRQC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBADSLT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBFONT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EBUSY: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECANCELED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECHILD: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECHO: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHOCTL: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHOE: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHOK: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHOKE: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHONL: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHOPRT: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ECHRNG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECOMM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECONNABORTED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECONNREFUSED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ECONNRESET: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDEADLK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDEADLOCK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDESTADDRREQ: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDIED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDOM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDOTDOT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EDQUOT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EEXIST: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EFAULT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EFBIG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EFTYPE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EGRATUITOUS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EGREGIOUS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EHOSTDOWN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EHOSTUNREACH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EHWPOISON: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EIDRM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EIEIO: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EILSEQ: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EINPROGRESS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EINTR: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EINVAL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EIO: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EISCONN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EISDIR: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EISNAM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EKEYEXPIRED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EKEYREJECTED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EKEYREVOKED: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EL2HLT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EL2NSYNC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EL3HLT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EL3RST: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELIBACC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELIBBAD: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELIBEXEC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELIBMAX: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELIBSCN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELNRNG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ELOOP: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EMEDIUMTYPE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EMFILE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EMLINK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EMSGSIZE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EMULTIHOP: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENAMETOOLONG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENAVAIL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENEEDAUTH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENETDOWN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENETRESET: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENETUNREACH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENFILE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOANO: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOBUFS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOCSI: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENODATA: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENODEV: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOENT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOEXEC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOKEY: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOLCK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOLINK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOMEDIUM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOMEM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOMSG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENONET: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOPKG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOPROTOOPT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOSPC: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOSR: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOSTR: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOSYS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTBLK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTCONN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTDIR: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTEMPTY: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTNAM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTRECOVERABLE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTSOCK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTSUP: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTTY: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENOTUNIQ: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ENXIO: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EOF: (libc)EOF and Errors.
|
||
* EOPNOTSUPP: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EOVERFLOW: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EOWNERDEAD: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPERM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPFNOSUPPORT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPIPE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROCLIM: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROCUNAVAIL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROGMISMATCH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROGUNAVAIL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROTO: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROTONOSUPPORT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EPROTOTYPE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EQUIV_CLASS_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* ERANGE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EREMCHG: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EREMOTE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EREMOTEIO: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ERESTART: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ERFKILL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EROFS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ERPCMISMATCH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESHUTDOWN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESOCKTNOSUPPORT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESPIPE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESRCH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESRMNT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESTALE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ESTRPIPE: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ETIME: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ETIMEDOUT: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ETOOMANYREFS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* ETXTBSY: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EUCLEAN: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EUNATCH: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EUSERS: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EWOULDBLOCK: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EXDEV: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EXFULL: (libc)Error Codes.
|
||
* EXIT_FAILURE: (libc)Exit Status.
|
||
* EXIT_SUCCESS: (libc)Exit Status.
|
||
* EXPR_NEST_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* FD_CLOEXEC: (libc)Descriptor Flags.
|
||
* FD_CLR: (libc)Waiting for I/O.
|
||
* FD_ISSET: (libc)Waiting for I/O.
|
||
* FD_SET: (libc)Waiting for I/O.
|
||
* FD_SETSIZE: (libc)Waiting for I/O.
|
||
* FD_ZERO: (libc)Waiting for I/O.
|
||
* FE_SNANS_ALWAYS_SIGNAL: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* FILENAME_MAX: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* FLUSHO: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* FOPEN_MAX: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* FP_ILOGB0: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* FP_ILOGBNAN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* FP_LLOGB0: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* FP_LLOGBNAN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* F_DUPFD: (libc)Duplicating Descriptors.
|
||
* F_GETFD: (libc)Descriptor Flags.
|
||
* F_GETFL: (libc)Getting File Status Flags.
|
||
* F_GETLK: (libc)File Locks.
|
||
* F_GETOWN: (libc)Interrupt Input.
|
||
* F_OFD_GETLK: (libc)Open File Description Locks.
|
||
* F_OFD_SETLK: (libc)Open File Description Locks.
|
||
* F_OFD_SETLKW: (libc)Open File Description Locks.
|
||
* F_OK: (libc)Testing File Access.
|
||
* F_SETFD: (libc)Descriptor Flags.
|
||
* F_SETFL: (libc)Getting File Status Flags.
|
||
* F_SETLK: (libc)File Locks.
|
||
* F_SETLKW: (libc)File Locks.
|
||
* F_SETOWN: (libc)Interrupt Input.
|
||
* HAS_CPU_FEATURE: (libc)X86.
|
||
* HUGE_VAL: (libc)Math Error Reporting.
|
||
* HUGE_VALF: (libc)Math Error Reporting.
|
||
* HUGE_VALL: (libc)Math Error Reporting.
|
||
* HUGE_VAL_FN: (libc)Math Error Reporting.
|
||
* HUGE_VAL_FNx: (libc)Math Error Reporting.
|
||
* HUPCL: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* I: (libc)Complex Numbers.
|
||
* ICANON: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ICRNL: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IEXTEN: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* IFNAMSIZ: (libc)Interface Naming.
|
||
* IFTODT: (libc)Directory Entries.
|
||
* IGNBRK: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IGNCR: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IGNPAR: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IMAXBEL: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* INADDR_ANY: (libc)Host Address Data Type.
|
||
* INADDR_BROADCAST: (libc)Host Address Data Type.
|
||
* INADDR_LOOPBACK: (libc)Host Address Data Type.
|
||
* INADDR_NONE: (libc)Host Address Data Type.
|
||
* INFINITY: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* INLCR: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* INPCK: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IPPORT_RESERVED: (libc)Ports.
|
||
* IPPORT_USERRESERVED: (libc)Ports.
|
||
* ISIG: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* ISTRIP: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IXANY: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IXOFF: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* IXON: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* LINE_MAX: (libc)Utility Limits.
|
||
* LINK_MAX: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* L_ctermid: (libc)Identifying the Terminal.
|
||
* L_cuserid: (libc)Who Logged In.
|
||
* L_tmpnam: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* MAXNAMLEN: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* MAXSYMLINKS: (libc)Symbolic Links.
|
||
* MAX_CANON: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* MAX_INPUT: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* MB_CUR_MAX: (libc)Selecting the Conversion.
|
||
* MB_LEN_MAX: (libc)Selecting the Conversion.
|
||
* MDMBUF: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* MSG_DONTROUTE: (libc)Socket Data Options.
|
||
* MSG_OOB: (libc)Socket Data Options.
|
||
* MSG_PEEK: (libc)Socket Data Options.
|
||
* NAME_MAX: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* NAN: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* NCCS: (libc)Mode Data Types.
|
||
* NGROUPS_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* NOFLSH: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* NOKERNINFO: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* NSIG: (libc)Standard Signals.
|
||
* NULL: (libc)Null Pointer Constant.
|
||
* ONLCR: (libc)Output Modes.
|
||
* ONOEOT: (libc)Output Modes.
|
||
* OPEN_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* OPOST: (libc)Output Modes.
|
||
* OXTABS: (libc)Output Modes.
|
||
* O_ACCMODE: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_APPEND: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_ASYNC: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_CREAT: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_DIRECTORY: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_EXCL: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_EXEC: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_EXLOCK: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_FSYNC: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_IGNORE_CTTY: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_NDELAY: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_NOATIME: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_NOCTTY: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_NOFOLLOW: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_NOLINK: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_NONBLOCK: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_NONBLOCK: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_NOTRANS: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_PATH: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_RDONLY: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_RDWR: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_READ: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_SHLOCK: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_SYNC: (libc)Operating Modes.
|
||
* O_TMPFILE: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_TRUNC: (libc)Open-time Flags.
|
||
* O_WRITE: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* O_WRONLY: (libc)Access Modes.
|
||
* PARENB: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* PARMRK: (libc)Input Modes.
|
||
* PARODD: (libc)Control Modes.
|
||
* PATH_MAX: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* PA_FLAG_MASK: (libc)Parsing a Template String.
|
||
* PENDIN: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* PF_FILE: (libc)Local Namespace Details.
|
||
* PF_INET6: (libc)Internet Namespace.
|
||
* PF_INET: (libc)Internet Namespace.
|
||
* PF_LOCAL: (libc)Local Namespace Details.
|
||
* PF_UNIX: (libc)Local Namespace Details.
|
||
* PIPE_BUF: (libc)Limits for Files.
|
||
* PTHREAD_ATTR_NO_SIGMASK_NP: (libc)Initial Thread Signal Mask.
|
||
* P_tmpdir: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* RAND_MAX: (libc)ISO Random.
|
||
* RE_DUP_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* RLIM_INFINITY: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* R_OK: (libc)Testing File Access.
|
||
* SA_NOCLDSTOP: (libc)Flags for Sigaction.
|
||
* SA_ONSTACK: (libc)Flags for Sigaction.
|
||
* SA_RESTART: (libc)Flags for Sigaction.
|
||
* SEEK_CUR: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* SEEK_END: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* SEEK_SET: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* SIGABRT: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGALRM: (libc)Alarm Signals.
|
||
* SIGBUS: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGCHLD: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGCLD: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGCONT: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGEMT: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGFPE: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGHUP: (libc)Termination Signals.
|
||
* SIGILL: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGINFO: (libc)Miscellaneous Signals.
|
||
* SIGINT: (libc)Termination Signals.
|
||
* SIGIO: (libc)Asynchronous I/O Signals.
|
||
* SIGIOT: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGKILL: (libc)Termination Signals.
|
||
* SIGLOST: (libc)Operation Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGPIPE: (libc)Operation Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGPOLL: (libc)Asynchronous I/O Signals.
|
||
* SIGPROF: (libc)Alarm Signals.
|
||
* SIGQUIT: (libc)Termination Signals.
|
||
* SIGSEGV: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGSTOP: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGSYS: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGTERM: (libc)Termination Signals.
|
||
* SIGTRAP: (libc)Program Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGTSTP: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGTTIN: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGTTOU: (libc)Job Control Signals.
|
||
* SIGURG: (libc)Asynchronous I/O Signals.
|
||
* SIGUSR1: (libc)Miscellaneous Signals.
|
||
* SIGUSR2: (libc)Miscellaneous Signals.
|
||
* SIGVTALRM: (libc)Alarm Signals.
|
||
* SIGWINCH: (libc)Miscellaneous Signals.
|
||
* SIGXCPU: (libc)Operation Error Signals.
|
||
* SIGXFSZ: (libc)Operation Error Signals.
|
||
* SIG_ERR: (libc)Basic Signal Handling.
|
||
* SNAN: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* SNANF: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* SNANFN: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* SNANFNx: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* SNANL: (libc)Infinity and NaN.
|
||
* SOCK_DGRAM: (libc)Communication Styles.
|
||
* SOCK_RAW: (libc)Communication Styles.
|
||
* SOCK_RDM: (libc)Communication Styles.
|
||
* SOCK_SEQPACKET: (libc)Communication Styles.
|
||
* SOCK_STREAM: (libc)Communication Styles.
|
||
* SOL_SOCKET: (libc)Socket-Level Options.
|
||
* SSIZE_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* STREAM_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* SUN_LEN: (libc)Local Namespace Details.
|
||
* S_IFMT: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISBLK: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISCHR: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISDIR: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISFIFO: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISLNK: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISREG: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_ISSOCK: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_TYPEISMQ: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_TYPEISSEM: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* S_TYPEISSHM: (libc)Testing File Type.
|
||
* TMP_MAX: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* TOSTOP: (libc)Local Modes.
|
||
* TZNAME_MAX: (libc)General Limits.
|
||
* VDISCARD: (libc)Other Special.
|
||
* VDSUSP: (libc)Signal Characters.
|
||
* VEOF: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* VEOL2: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* VEOL: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* VERASE: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* VINTR: (libc)Signal Characters.
|
||
* VKILL: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* VLNEXT: (libc)Other Special.
|
||
* VMIN: (libc)Noncanonical Input.
|
||
* VQUIT: (libc)Signal Characters.
|
||
* VREPRINT: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* VSTART: (libc)Start/Stop Characters.
|
||
* VSTATUS: (libc)Other Special.
|
||
* VSTOP: (libc)Start/Stop Characters.
|
||
* VSUSP: (libc)Signal Characters.
|
||
* VTIME: (libc)Noncanonical Input.
|
||
* VWERASE: (libc)Editing Characters.
|
||
* WCHAR_MAX: (libc)Extended Char Intro.
|
||
* WCHAR_MIN: (libc)Extended Char Intro.
|
||
* WCOREDUMP: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* WEOF: (libc)EOF and Errors.
|
||
* WEOF: (libc)Extended Char Intro.
|
||
* WEXITSTATUS: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* WIFEXITED: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* WIFSIGNALED: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* WIFSTOPPED: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* WSTOPSIG: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* WTERMSIG: (libc)Process Completion Status.
|
||
* W_OK: (libc)Testing File Access.
|
||
* X_OK: (libc)Testing File Access.
|
||
* _Complex_I: (libc)Complex Numbers.
|
||
* _Exit: (libc)Termination Internals.
|
||
* _IOFBF: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* _IOLBF: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* _IONBF: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* _Imaginary_I: (libc)Complex Numbers.
|
||
* _PATH_UTMP: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* _PATH_WTMP: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* _POSIX2_C_DEV: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX2_C_VERSION: (libc)Version Supported.
|
||
* _POSIX2_FORT_DEV: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX2_FORT_RUN: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX2_LOCALEDEF: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX2_SW_DEV: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX_CHOWN_RESTRICTED: (libc)Options for Files.
|
||
* _POSIX_JOB_CONTROL: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX_NO_TRUNC: (libc)Options for Files.
|
||
* _POSIX_SAVED_IDS: (libc)System Options.
|
||
* _POSIX_VDISABLE: (libc)Options for Files.
|
||
* _POSIX_VERSION: (libc)Version Supported.
|
||
* __fbufsize: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* __flbf: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* __fpending: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* __fpurge: (libc)Flushing Buffers.
|
||
* __freadable: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* __freading: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* __fsetlocking: (libc)Streams and Threads.
|
||
* __fwritable: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* __fwriting: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* __gconv_end_fct: (libc)glibc iconv Implementation.
|
||
* __gconv_fct: (libc)glibc iconv Implementation.
|
||
* __gconv_init_fct: (libc)glibc iconv Implementation.
|
||
* __ppc_get_timebase: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_get_timebase_freq: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_mdoio: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_mdoom: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_set_ppr_low: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_set_ppr_med: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_set_ppr_med_high: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_set_ppr_med_low: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_set_ppr_very_low: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __ppc_yield: (libc)PowerPC.
|
||
* __riscv_flush_icache: (libc)RISC-V.
|
||
* __va_copy: (libc)Argument Macros.
|
||
* __x86_get_cpuid_feature_leaf: (libc)X86.
|
||
* _exit: (libc)Termination Internals.
|
||
* _flushlbf: (libc)Flushing Buffers.
|
||
* _tolower: (libc)Case Conversion.
|
||
* _toupper: (libc)Case Conversion.
|
||
* a64l: (libc)Encode Binary Data.
|
||
* abort: (libc)Aborting a Program.
|
||
* abs: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* accept: (libc)Accepting Connections.
|
||
* access: (libc)Testing File Access.
|
||
* acos: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* acosf: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* acosfN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* acosfNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* acosh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* acoshf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* acoshfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* acoshfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* acoshl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* acosl: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* addmntent: (libc)mtab.
|
||
* addseverity: (libc)Adding Severity Classes.
|
||
* adjtime: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* adjtimex: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* aio_cancel64: (libc)Cancel AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_cancel: (libc)Cancel AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_error64: (libc)Status of AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_error: (libc)Status of AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_fsync64: (libc)Synchronizing AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_fsync: (libc)Synchronizing AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_init: (libc)Configuration of AIO.
|
||
* aio_read64: (libc)Asynchronous Reads/Writes.
|
||
* aio_read: (libc)Asynchronous Reads/Writes.
|
||
* aio_return64: (libc)Status of AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_return: (libc)Status of AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_suspend64: (libc)Synchronizing AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_suspend: (libc)Synchronizing AIO Operations.
|
||
* aio_write64: (libc)Asynchronous Reads/Writes.
|
||
* aio_write: (libc)Asynchronous Reads/Writes.
|
||
* alarm: (libc)Setting an Alarm.
|
||
* aligned_alloc: (libc)Aligned Memory Blocks.
|
||
* alloca: (libc)Variable Size Automatic.
|
||
* alphasort64: (libc)Scanning Directory Content.
|
||
* alphasort: (libc)Scanning Directory Content.
|
||
* argp_error: (libc)Argp Helper Functions.
|
||
* argp_failure: (libc)Argp Helper Functions.
|
||
* argp_help: (libc)Argp Help.
|
||
* argp_parse: (libc)Argp.
|
||
* argp_state_help: (libc)Argp Helper Functions.
|
||
* argp_usage: (libc)Argp Helper Functions.
|
||
* argz_add: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_add_sep: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_append: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_count: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_create: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_create_sep: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_delete: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_extract: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_insert: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_next: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_replace: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* argz_stringify: (libc)Argz Functions.
|
||
* asctime: (libc)Formatting Calendar Time.
|
||
* asctime_r: (libc)Formatting Calendar Time.
|
||
* asin: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* asinf: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* asinfN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* asinfNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* asinh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* asinhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* asinhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* asinhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* asinhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* asinl: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* asprintf: (libc)Dynamic Output.
|
||
* assert: (libc)Consistency Checking.
|
||
* assert_perror: (libc)Consistency Checking.
|
||
* atan2: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atan2f: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atan2fN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atan2fNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atan2l: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atan: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atanf: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atanfN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atanfNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atanh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* atanhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* atanhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* atanhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* atanhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* atanl: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* atexit: (libc)Cleanups on Exit.
|
||
* atof: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* atoi: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* atol: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* atoll: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* backtrace: (libc)Backtraces.
|
||
* backtrace_symbols: (libc)Backtraces.
|
||
* backtrace_symbols_fd: (libc)Backtraces.
|
||
* basename: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* basename: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* bcmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* bcopy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* bind: (libc)Setting Address.
|
||
* bind_textdomain_codeset: (libc)Charset conversion in gettext.
|
||
* bindtextdomain: (libc)Locating gettext catalog.
|
||
* brk: (libc)Resizing the Data Segment.
|
||
* bsearch: (libc)Array Search Function.
|
||
* btowc: (libc)Converting a Character.
|
||
* bzero: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* cabs: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* cabsf: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* cabsfN: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* cabsfNx: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* cabsl: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* cacos: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* cacosf: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* cacosfN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* cacosfNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* cacosh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* cacoshf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* cacoshfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* cacoshfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* cacoshl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* cacosl: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* call_once: (libc)Call Once.
|
||
* calloc: (libc)Allocating Cleared Space.
|
||
* canonicalize: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* canonicalize_file_name: (libc)Symbolic Links.
|
||
* canonicalizef: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* canonicalizefN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* canonicalizefNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* canonicalizel: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* carg: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cargf: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cargfN: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cargfNx: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cargl: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* casin: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* casinf: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* casinfN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* casinfNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* casinh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* casinhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* casinhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* casinhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* casinhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* casinl: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* catan: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* catanf: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* catanfN: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* catanfNx: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* catanh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* catanhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* catanhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* catanhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* catanhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* catanl: (libc)Inverse Trig Functions.
|
||
* catclose: (libc)The catgets Functions.
|
||
* catgets: (libc)The catgets Functions.
|
||
* catopen: (libc)The catgets Functions.
|
||
* cbrt: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cbrtf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cbrtfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cbrtfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cbrtl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* ccos: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ccosf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ccosfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ccosfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ccosh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ccoshf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ccoshfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ccoshfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ccoshl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ccosl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ceil: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ceilf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ceilfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ceilfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ceill: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* cexp: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cexpf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cexpfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cexpfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cexpl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cfgetispeed: (libc)Line Speed.
|
||
* cfgetospeed: (libc)Line Speed.
|
||
* cfmakeraw: (libc)Noncanonical Input.
|
||
* cfsetispeed: (libc)Line Speed.
|
||
* cfsetospeed: (libc)Line Speed.
|
||
* cfsetspeed: (libc)Line Speed.
|
||
* chdir: (libc)Working Directory.
|
||
* chmod: (libc)Setting Permissions.
|
||
* chown: (libc)File Owner.
|
||
* cimag: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cimagf: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cimagfN: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cimagfNx: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cimagl: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* clearenv: (libc)Environment Access.
|
||
* clearerr: (libc)Error Recovery.
|
||
* clearerr_unlocked: (libc)Error Recovery.
|
||
* clock: (libc)CPU Time.
|
||
* clock_getres: (libc)Getting the Time.
|
||
* clock_gettime: (libc)Getting the Time.
|
||
* clock_settime: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* clog10: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clog10f: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clog10fN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clog10fNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clog10l: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clog: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clogf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clogfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clogfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* clogl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* close: (libc)Opening and Closing Files.
|
||
* closedir: (libc)Reading/Closing Directory.
|
||
* closelog: (libc)closelog.
|
||
* cnd_broadcast: (libc)ISO C Condition Variables.
|
||
* cnd_destroy: (libc)ISO C Condition Variables.
|
||
* cnd_init: (libc)ISO C Condition Variables.
|
||
* cnd_signal: (libc)ISO C Condition Variables.
|
||
* cnd_timedwait: (libc)ISO C Condition Variables.
|
||
* cnd_wait: (libc)ISO C Condition Variables.
|
||
* confstr: (libc)String Parameters.
|
||
* conj: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* conjf: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* conjfN: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* conjfNx: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* conjl: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* connect: (libc)Connecting.
|
||
* copy_file_range: (libc)Copying File Data.
|
||
* copysign: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* copysignf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* copysignfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* copysignfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* copysignl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* cos: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* cosf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* cosfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* cosfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* cosh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* coshf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* coshfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* coshfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* coshl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* cosl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* cpow: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cpowf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cpowfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cpowfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cpowl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* cproj: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cprojf: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cprojfN: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cprojfNx: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* cprojl: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* creal: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* crealf: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* crealfN: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* crealfNx: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* creall: (libc)Operations on Complex.
|
||
* creat64: (libc)Opening and Closing Files.
|
||
* creat: (libc)Opening and Closing Files.
|
||
* crypt: (libc)Passphrase Storage.
|
||
* crypt_r: (libc)Passphrase Storage.
|
||
* csin: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* csinf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* csinfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* csinfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* csinh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* csinhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* csinhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* csinhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* csinhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* csinl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* csqrt: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* csqrtf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* csqrtfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* csqrtfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* csqrtl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* ctan: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ctanf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ctanfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ctanfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ctanh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ctanhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ctanhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ctanhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ctanhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* ctanl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* ctermid: (libc)Identifying the Terminal.
|
||
* ctime: (libc)Formatting Calendar Time.
|
||
* ctime_r: (libc)Formatting Calendar Time.
|
||
* cuserid: (libc)Who Logged In.
|
||
* daddl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* dcgettext: (libc)Translation with gettext.
|
||
* dcngettext: (libc)Advanced gettext functions.
|
||
* ddivl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* dgettext: (libc)Translation with gettext.
|
||
* difftime: (libc)Calculating Elapsed Time.
|
||
* dirfd: (libc)Opening a Directory.
|
||
* dirname: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* div: (libc)Integer Division.
|
||
* dmull: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* dngettext: (libc)Advanced gettext functions.
|
||
* drand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* drand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* drem: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* dremf: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* dreml: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* dsubl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* dup2: (libc)Duplicating Descriptors.
|
||
* dup: (libc)Duplicating Descriptors.
|
||
* ecvt: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* ecvt_r: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* endfsent: (libc)fstab.
|
||
* endgrent: (libc)Scanning All Groups.
|
||
* endhostent: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* endmntent: (libc)mtab.
|
||
* endnetent: (libc)Networks Database.
|
||
* endnetgrent: (libc)Lookup Netgroup.
|
||
* endprotoent: (libc)Protocols Database.
|
||
* endpwent: (libc)Scanning All Users.
|
||
* endservent: (libc)Services Database.
|
||
* endutent: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* endutxent: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* envz_add: (libc)Envz Functions.
|
||
* envz_entry: (libc)Envz Functions.
|
||
* envz_get: (libc)Envz Functions.
|
||
* envz_merge: (libc)Envz Functions.
|
||
* envz_remove: (libc)Envz Functions.
|
||
* envz_strip: (libc)Envz Functions.
|
||
* erand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* erand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* erf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erfc: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erfcf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erfcfN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erfcfNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erfcl: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erff: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erffN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erffNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* erfl: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* err: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* errno: (libc)Checking for Errors.
|
||
* error: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* error_at_line: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* errx: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* execl: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* execle: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* execlp: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* execv: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* execve: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* execvp: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* exit: (libc)Normal Termination.
|
||
* exp10: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp10f: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp10fN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp10fNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp10l: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp2: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp2f: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp2fN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp2fNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp2l: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* exp: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* explicit_bzero: (libc)Erasing Sensitive Data.
|
||
* expm1: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expm1f: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expm1fN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expm1fNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* expm1l: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* fMaddfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMaddfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMdivfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMdivfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMmulfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMmulfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMsubfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMsubfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxaddfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxaddfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxdivfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxdivfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxmulfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxmulfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxsubfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fMxsubfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fabs: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* fabsf: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* fabsfN: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* fabsfNx: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* fabsl: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* fadd: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* faddl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fchdir: (libc)Working Directory.
|
||
* fchmod: (libc)Setting Permissions.
|
||
* fchown: (libc)File Owner.
|
||
* fclose: (libc)Closing Streams.
|
||
* fcloseall: (libc)Closing Streams.
|
||
* fcntl: (libc)Control Operations.
|
||
* fcvt: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* fcvt_r: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* fdatasync: (libc)Synchronizing I/O.
|
||
* fdim: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdimf: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdimfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdimfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdiml: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdiv: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdivl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fdopen: (libc)Descriptors and Streams.
|
||
* fdopendir: (libc)Opening a Directory.
|
||
* feclearexcept: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* fedisableexcept: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* feenableexcept: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fegetenv: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fegetexcept: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fegetexceptflag: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* fegetmode: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fegetround: (libc)Rounding.
|
||
* feholdexcept: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* feof: (libc)EOF and Errors.
|
||
* feof_unlocked: (libc)EOF and Errors.
|
||
* feraiseexcept: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* ferror: (libc)EOF and Errors.
|
||
* ferror_unlocked: (libc)EOF and Errors.
|
||
* fesetenv: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fesetexcept: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* fesetexceptflag: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* fesetmode: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fesetround: (libc)Rounding.
|
||
* fetestexcept: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* fetestexceptflag: (libc)Status bit operations.
|
||
* feupdateenv: (libc)Control Functions.
|
||
* fexecve: (libc)Executing a File.
|
||
* fflush: (libc)Flushing Buffers.
|
||
* fflush_unlocked: (libc)Flushing Buffers.
|
||
* fgetc: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* fgetc_unlocked: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* fgetgrent: (libc)Scanning All Groups.
|
||
* fgetgrent_r: (libc)Scanning All Groups.
|
||
* fgetpos64: (libc)Portable Positioning.
|
||
* fgetpos: (libc)Portable Positioning.
|
||
* fgetpwent: (libc)Scanning All Users.
|
||
* fgetpwent_r: (libc)Scanning All Users.
|
||
* fgets: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* fgets_unlocked: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* fgetwc: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* fgetwc_unlocked: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* fgetws: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* fgetws_unlocked: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* fileno: (libc)Descriptors and Streams.
|
||
* fileno_unlocked: (libc)Descriptors and Streams.
|
||
* finite: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* finitef: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* finitel: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* flockfile: (libc)Streams and Threads.
|
||
* floor: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* floorf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* floorfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* floorfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* floorl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fma: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaf: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmafN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmafNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmal: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmax: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxf: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxmag: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxmagf: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxmagfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxmagfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmaxmagl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmemopen: (libc)String Streams.
|
||
* fmin: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminf: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminmag: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminmagf: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminmagfN: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminmagfNx: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fminmagl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmod: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* fmodf: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* fmodfN: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* fmodfNx: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* fmodl: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* fmtmsg: (libc)Printing Formatted Messages.
|
||
* fmul: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fmull: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fnmatch: (libc)Wildcard Matching.
|
||
* fopen64: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* fopen: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* fopencookie: (libc)Streams and Cookies.
|
||
* fork: (libc)Creating a Process.
|
||
* forkpty: (libc)Pseudo-Terminal Pairs.
|
||
* fpathconf: (libc)Pathconf.
|
||
* fpclassify: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* fprintf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* fputc: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputc_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputs: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputs_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputwc: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputwc_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputws: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fputws_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* fread: (libc)Block Input/Output.
|
||
* fread_unlocked: (libc)Block Input/Output.
|
||
* free: (libc)Freeing after Malloc.
|
||
* freopen64: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* freopen: (libc)Opening Streams.
|
||
* frexp: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* frexpf: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* frexpfN: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* frexpfNx: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* frexpl: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* fromfp: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpxf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpxfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpxfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fromfpxl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* fscanf: (libc)Formatted Input Functions.
|
||
* fseek: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* fseeko64: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* fseeko: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* fsetpos64: (libc)Portable Positioning.
|
||
* fsetpos: (libc)Portable Positioning.
|
||
* fstat64: (libc)Reading Attributes.
|
||
* fstat: (libc)Reading Attributes.
|
||
* fsub: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fsubl: (libc)Misc FP Arithmetic.
|
||
* fsync: (libc)Synchronizing I/O.
|
||
* ftell: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* ftello64: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* ftello: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* ftruncate64: (libc)File Size.
|
||
* ftruncate: (libc)File Size.
|
||
* ftrylockfile: (libc)Streams and Threads.
|
||
* ftw64: (libc)Working with Directory Trees.
|
||
* ftw: (libc)Working with Directory Trees.
|
||
* funlockfile: (libc)Streams and Threads.
|
||
* futimes: (libc)File Times.
|
||
* fwide: (libc)Streams and I18N.
|
||
* fwprintf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* fwrite: (libc)Block Input/Output.
|
||
* fwrite_unlocked: (libc)Block Input/Output.
|
||
* fwscanf: (libc)Formatted Input Functions.
|
||
* gamma: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* gammaf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* gammal: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* gcvt: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* get_avphys_pages: (libc)Query Memory Parameters.
|
||
* get_current_dir_name: (libc)Working Directory.
|
||
* get_nprocs: (libc)Processor Resources.
|
||
* get_nprocs_conf: (libc)Processor Resources.
|
||
* get_phys_pages: (libc)Query Memory Parameters.
|
||
* getauxval: (libc)Auxiliary Vector.
|
||
* getc: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getc_unlocked: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getchar: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getchar_unlocked: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getcontext: (libc)System V contexts.
|
||
* getcpu: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* getcwd: (libc)Working Directory.
|
||
* getdate: (libc)General Time String Parsing.
|
||
* getdate_r: (libc)General Time String Parsing.
|
||
* getdelim: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* getdents64: (libc)Low-level Directory Access.
|
||
* getdomainnname: (libc)Host Identification.
|
||
* getegid: (libc)Reading Persona.
|
||
* getentropy: (libc)Unpredictable Bytes.
|
||
* getenv: (libc)Environment Access.
|
||
* geteuid: (libc)Reading Persona.
|
||
* getfsent: (libc)fstab.
|
||
* getfsfile: (libc)fstab.
|
||
* getfsspec: (libc)fstab.
|
||
* getgid: (libc)Reading Persona.
|
||
* getgrent: (libc)Scanning All Groups.
|
||
* getgrent_r: (libc)Scanning All Groups.
|
||
* getgrgid: (libc)Lookup Group.
|
||
* getgrgid_r: (libc)Lookup Group.
|
||
* getgrnam: (libc)Lookup Group.
|
||
* getgrnam_r: (libc)Lookup Group.
|
||
* getgrouplist: (libc)Setting Groups.
|
||
* getgroups: (libc)Reading Persona.
|
||
* gethostbyaddr: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostbyaddr_r: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostbyname2: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostbyname2_r: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostbyname: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostbyname_r: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostent: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* gethostid: (libc)Host Identification.
|
||
* gethostname: (libc)Host Identification.
|
||
* getitimer: (libc)Setting an Alarm.
|
||
* getline: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* getloadavg: (libc)Processor Resources.
|
||
* getlogin: (libc)Who Logged In.
|
||
* getmntent: (libc)mtab.
|
||
* getmntent_r: (libc)mtab.
|
||
* getnetbyaddr: (libc)Networks Database.
|
||
* getnetbyname: (libc)Networks Database.
|
||
* getnetent: (libc)Networks Database.
|
||
* getnetgrent: (libc)Lookup Netgroup.
|
||
* getnetgrent_r: (libc)Lookup Netgroup.
|
||
* getopt: (libc)Using Getopt.
|
||
* getopt_long: (libc)Getopt Long Options.
|
||
* getopt_long_only: (libc)Getopt Long Options.
|
||
* getpagesize: (libc)Query Memory Parameters.
|
||
* getpass: (libc)getpass.
|
||
* getpayload: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* getpayloadf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* getpayloadfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* getpayloadfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* getpayloadl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* getpeername: (libc)Who is Connected.
|
||
* getpgid: (libc)Process Group Functions.
|
||
* getpgrp: (libc)Process Group Functions.
|
||
* getpid: (libc)Process Identification.
|
||
* getppid: (libc)Process Identification.
|
||
* getpriority: (libc)Traditional Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* getprotobyname: (libc)Protocols Database.
|
||
* getprotobynumber: (libc)Protocols Database.
|
||
* getprotoent: (libc)Protocols Database.
|
||
* getpt: (libc)Allocation.
|
||
* getpwent: (libc)Scanning All Users.
|
||
* getpwent_r: (libc)Scanning All Users.
|
||
* getpwnam: (libc)Lookup User.
|
||
* getpwnam_r: (libc)Lookup User.
|
||
* getpwuid: (libc)Lookup User.
|
||
* getpwuid_r: (libc)Lookup User.
|
||
* getrandom: (libc)Unpredictable Bytes.
|
||
* getrlimit64: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* getrlimit: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* getrusage: (libc)Resource Usage.
|
||
* gets: (libc)Line Input.
|
||
* getservbyname: (libc)Services Database.
|
||
* getservbyport: (libc)Services Database.
|
||
* getservent: (libc)Services Database.
|
||
* getsid: (libc)Process Group Functions.
|
||
* getsockname: (libc)Reading Address.
|
||
* getsockopt: (libc)Socket Option Functions.
|
||
* getsubopt: (libc)Suboptions.
|
||
* gettext: (libc)Translation with gettext.
|
||
* gettid: (libc)Process Identification.
|
||
* gettimeofday: (libc)Getting the Time.
|
||
* getuid: (libc)Reading Persona.
|
||
* getumask: (libc)Setting Permissions.
|
||
* getutent: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* getutent_r: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* getutid: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* getutid_r: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* getutline: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* getutline_r: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* getutmp: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* getutmpx: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* getutxent: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* getutxid: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* getutxline: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* getw: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getwc: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getwc_unlocked: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getwchar: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getwchar_unlocked: (libc)Character Input.
|
||
* getwd: (libc)Working Directory.
|
||
* glob64: (libc)Calling Glob.
|
||
* glob: (libc)Calling Glob.
|
||
* globfree64: (libc)More Flags for Globbing.
|
||
* globfree: (libc)More Flags for Globbing.
|
||
* gmtime: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* gmtime_r: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* grantpt: (libc)Allocation.
|
||
* gsignal: (libc)Signaling Yourself.
|
||
* gtty: (libc)BSD Terminal Modes.
|
||
* hasmntopt: (libc)mtab.
|
||
* hcreate: (libc)Hash Search Function.
|
||
* hcreate_r: (libc)Hash Search Function.
|
||
* hdestroy: (libc)Hash Search Function.
|
||
* hdestroy_r: (libc)Hash Search Function.
|
||
* hsearch: (libc)Hash Search Function.
|
||
* hsearch_r: (libc)Hash Search Function.
|
||
* htonl: (libc)Byte Order.
|
||
* htons: (libc)Byte Order.
|
||
* hypot: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* hypotf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* hypotfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* hypotfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* hypotl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* iconv: (libc)Generic Conversion Interface.
|
||
* iconv_close: (libc)Generic Conversion Interface.
|
||
* iconv_open: (libc)Generic Conversion Interface.
|
||
* if_freenameindex: (libc)Interface Naming.
|
||
* if_indextoname: (libc)Interface Naming.
|
||
* if_nameindex: (libc)Interface Naming.
|
||
* if_nametoindex: (libc)Interface Naming.
|
||
* ilogb: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* ilogbf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* ilogbfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* ilogbfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* ilogbl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* imaxabs: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* imaxdiv: (libc)Integer Division.
|
||
* in6addr_any: (libc)Host Address Data Type.
|
||
* in6addr_loopback: (libc)Host Address Data Type.
|
||
* index: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* inet_addr: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_aton: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_lnaof: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_makeaddr: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_netof: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_network: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_ntoa: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_ntop: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* inet_pton: (libc)Host Address Functions.
|
||
* initgroups: (libc)Setting Groups.
|
||
* initstate: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* initstate_r: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* innetgr: (libc)Netgroup Membership.
|
||
* ioctl: (libc)IOCTLs.
|
||
* isalnum: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* isalpha: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* isascii: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* isatty: (libc)Is It a Terminal.
|
||
* isblank: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* iscanonical: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* iscntrl: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* isdigit: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* iseqsig: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* isfinite: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isgraph: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* isgreater: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* isgreaterequal: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* isinf: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isinff: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isinfl: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isless: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* islessequal: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* islessgreater: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* islower: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* isnan: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isnan: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isnanf: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isnanl: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isnormal: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isprint: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* ispunct: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* issignaling: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isspace: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* issubnormal: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* isunordered: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* isupper: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* iswalnum: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswalpha: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswblank: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswcntrl: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswctype: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswdigit: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswgraph: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswlower: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswprint: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswpunct: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswspace: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswupper: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* iswxdigit: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* isxdigit: (libc)Classification of Characters.
|
||
* iszero: (libc)Floating Point Classes.
|
||
* j0: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j0f: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j0fN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j0fNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j0l: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j1: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j1f: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j1fN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j1fNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* j1l: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* jn: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* jnf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* jnfN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* jnfNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* jnl: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* jrand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* jrand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* kill: (libc)Signaling Another Process.
|
||
* killpg: (libc)Signaling Another Process.
|
||
* l64a: (libc)Encode Binary Data.
|
||
* labs: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* lcong48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* lcong48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* ldexp: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* ldexpf: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* ldexpfN: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* ldexpfNx: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* ldexpl: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* ldiv: (libc)Integer Division.
|
||
* lfind: (libc)Array Search Function.
|
||
* lgamma: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgamma_r: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammaf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammafN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammafN_r: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammafNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammafNx_r: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammaf_r: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammal: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* lgammal_r: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* link: (libc)Hard Links.
|
||
* linkat: (libc)Hard Links.
|
||
* lio_listio64: (libc)Asynchronous Reads/Writes.
|
||
* lio_listio: (libc)Asynchronous Reads/Writes.
|
||
* listen: (libc)Listening.
|
||
* llabs: (libc)Absolute Value.
|
||
* lldiv: (libc)Integer Division.
|
||
* llogb: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* llogbf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* llogbfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* llogbfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* llogbl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* llrint: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llrintf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llrintfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llrintfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llrintl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llround: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llroundf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llroundfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llroundfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* llroundl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* localeconv: (libc)The Lame Way to Locale Data.
|
||
* localtime: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* localtime_r: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* log10: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log10f: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log10fN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log10fNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log10l: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log1p: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log1pf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log1pfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log1pfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log1pl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log2: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log2f: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log2fN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log2fNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log2l: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* log: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logb: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logbf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logbfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logbfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logbl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* login: (libc)Logging In and Out.
|
||
* login_tty: (libc)Logging In and Out.
|
||
* logl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* logout: (libc)Logging In and Out.
|
||
* logwtmp: (libc)Logging In and Out.
|
||
* longjmp: (libc)Non-Local Details.
|
||
* lrand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* lrand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* lrint: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lrintf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lrintfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lrintfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lrintl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lround: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lroundf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lroundfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lroundfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lroundl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* lsearch: (libc)Array Search Function.
|
||
* lseek64: (libc)File Position Primitive.
|
||
* lseek: (libc)File Position Primitive.
|
||
* lstat64: (libc)Reading Attributes.
|
||
* lstat: (libc)Reading Attributes.
|
||
* lutimes: (libc)File Times.
|
||
* madvise: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* makecontext: (libc)System V contexts.
|
||
* mallinfo2: (libc)Statistics of Malloc.
|
||
* malloc: (libc)Basic Allocation.
|
||
* mallopt: (libc)Malloc Tunable Parameters.
|
||
* mblen: (libc)Non-reentrant Character Conversion.
|
||
* mbrlen: (libc)Converting a Character.
|
||
* mbrtowc: (libc)Converting a Character.
|
||
* mbsinit: (libc)Keeping the state.
|
||
* mbsnrtowcs: (libc)Converting Strings.
|
||
* mbsrtowcs: (libc)Converting Strings.
|
||
* mbstowcs: (libc)Non-reentrant String Conversion.
|
||
* mbtowc: (libc)Non-reentrant Character Conversion.
|
||
* mcheck: (libc)Heap Consistency Checking.
|
||
* memalign: (libc)Aligned Memory Blocks.
|
||
* memccpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* memchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* memcmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* memcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* memfd_create: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* memfrob: (libc)Obfuscating Data.
|
||
* memmem: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* memmove: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* mempcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* memrchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* memset: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* mkdir: (libc)Creating Directories.
|
||
* mkdtemp: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* mkfifo: (libc)FIFO Special Files.
|
||
* mknod: (libc)Making Special Files.
|
||
* mkstemp: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* mktemp: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* mktime: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* mlock2: (libc)Page Lock Functions.
|
||
* mlock: (libc)Page Lock Functions.
|
||
* mlockall: (libc)Page Lock Functions.
|
||
* mmap64: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* mmap: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* modf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* modff: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* modffN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* modffNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* modfl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* mount: (libc)Mount-Unmount-Remount.
|
||
* mprobe: (libc)Heap Consistency Checking.
|
||
* mprotect: (libc)Memory Protection.
|
||
* mrand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* mrand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* mremap: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* msync: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* mtrace: (libc)Tracing malloc.
|
||
* mtx_destroy: (libc)ISO C Mutexes.
|
||
* mtx_init: (libc)ISO C Mutexes.
|
||
* mtx_lock: (libc)ISO C Mutexes.
|
||
* mtx_timedlock: (libc)ISO C Mutexes.
|
||
* mtx_trylock: (libc)ISO C Mutexes.
|
||
* mtx_unlock: (libc)ISO C Mutexes.
|
||
* munlock: (libc)Page Lock Functions.
|
||
* munlockall: (libc)Page Lock Functions.
|
||
* munmap: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* muntrace: (libc)Tracing malloc.
|
||
* nan: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nanf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nanfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nanfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nanl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nanosleep: (libc)Sleeping.
|
||
* nearbyint: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* nearbyintf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* nearbyintfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* nearbyintfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* nearbyintl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* nextafter: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextafterf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextafterfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextafterfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextafterl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextdown: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextdownf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextdownfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextdownfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextdownl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nexttoward: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nexttowardf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nexttowardl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextup: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextupf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextupfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextupfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nextupl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* nftw64: (libc)Working with Directory Trees.
|
||
* nftw: (libc)Working with Directory Trees.
|
||
* ngettext: (libc)Advanced gettext functions.
|
||
* nice: (libc)Traditional Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* nl_langinfo: (libc)The Elegant and Fast Way.
|
||
* nrand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* nrand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* ntohl: (libc)Byte Order.
|
||
* ntohs: (libc)Byte Order.
|
||
* ntp_adjtime: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* ntp_gettime: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* obstack_1grow: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_1grow_fast: (libc)Extra Fast Growing.
|
||
* obstack_alignment_mask: (libc)Obstacks Data Alignment.
|
||
* obstack_alloc: (libc)Allocation in an Obstack.
|
||
* obstack_base: (libc)Status of an Obstack.
|
||
* obstack_blank: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_blank_fast: (libc)Extra Fast Growing.
|
||
* obstack_chunk_size: (libc)Obstack Chunks.
|
||
* obstack_copy0: (libc)Allocation in an Obstack.
|
||
* obstack_copy: (libc)Allocation in an Obstack.
|
||
* obstack_finish: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_free: (libc)Freeing Obstack Objects.
|
||
* obstack_grow0: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_grow: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_init: (libc)Preparing for Obstacks.
|
||
* obstack_int_grow: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_int_grow_fast: (libc)Extra Fast Growing.
|
||
* obstack_next_free: (libc)Status of an Obstack.
|
||
* obstack_object_size: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_object_size: (libc)Status of an Obstack.
|
||
* obstack_printf: (libc)Dynamic Output.
|
||
* obstack_ptr_grow: (libc)Growing Objects.
|
||
* obstack_ptr_grow_fast: (libc)Extra Fast Growing.
|
||
* obstack_room: (libc)Extra Fast Growing.
|
||
* obstack_vprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* offsetof: (libc)Structure Measurement.
|
||
* on_exit: (libc)Cleanups on Exit.
|
||
* open64: (libc)Opening and Closing Files.
|
||
* open: (libc)Opening and Closing Files.
|
||
* open_memstream: (libc)String Streams.
|
||
* opendir: (libc)Opening a Directory.
|
||
* openlog: (libc)openlog.
|
||
* openpty: (libc)Pseudo-Terminal Pairs.
|
||
* parse_printf_format: (libc)Parsing a Template String.
|
||
* pathconf: (libc)Pathconf.
|
||
* pause: (libc)Using Pause.
|
||
* pclose: (libc)Pipe to a Subprocess.
|
||
* perror: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* pipe: (libc)Creating a Pipe.
|
||
* pkey_alloc: (libc)Memory Protection.
|
||
* pkey_free: (libc)Memory Protection.
|
||
* pkey_get: (libc)Memory Protection.
|
||
* pkey_mprotect: (libc)Memory Protection.
|
||
* pkey_set: (libc)Memory Protection.
|
||
* popen: (libc)Pipe to a Subprocess.
|
||
* posix_fallocate64: (libc)Storage Allocation.
|
||
* posix_fallocate: (libc)Storage Allocation.
|
||
* posix_memalign: (libc)Aligned Memory Blocks.
|
||
* pow: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* powf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* powfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* powfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* powl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* pread64: (libc)I/O Primitives.
|
||
* pread: (libc)I/O Primitives.
|
||
* preadv2: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* preadv64: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* preadv64v2: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* preadv: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* printf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* printf_size: (libc)Predefined Printf Handlers.
|
||
* printf_size_info: (libc)Predefined Printf Handlers.
|
||
* psignal: (libc)Signal Messages.
|
||
* pthread_attr_getsigmask_np: (libc)Initial Thread Signal Mask.
|
||
* pthread_attr_setsigmask_np: (libc)Initial Thread Signal Mask.
|
||
* pthread_clockjoin_np: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* pthread_cond_clockwait: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* pthread_getattr_default_np: (libc)Default Thread Attributes.
|
||
* pthread_getspecific: (libc)Thread-specific Data.
|
||
* pthread_key_create: (libc)Thread-specific Data.
|
||
* pthread_key_delete: (libc)Thread-specific Data.
|
||
* pthread_rwlock_clockrdlock: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* pthread_rwlock_clockwrlock: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* pthread_setattr_default_np: (libc)Default Thread Attributes.
|
||
* pthread_setspecific: (libc)Thread-specific Data.
|
||
* pthread_timedjoin_np: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* pthread_tryjoin_np: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* ptsname: (libc)Allocation.
|
||
* ptsname_r: (libc)Allocation.
|
||
* putc: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putc_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putchar: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putchar_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putenv: (libc)Environment Access.
|
||
* putpwent: (libc)Writing a User Entry.
|
||
* puts: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* pututline: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* pututxline: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* putw: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putwc: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putwc_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putwchar: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* putwchar_unlocked: (libc)Simple Output.
|
||
* pwrite64: (libc)I/O Primitives.
|
||
* pwrite: (libc)I/O Primitives.
|
||
* pwritev2: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* pwritev64: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* pwritev64v2: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* pwritev: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* qecvt: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* qecvt_r: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* qfcvt: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* qfcvt_r: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* qgcvt: (libc)System V Number Conversion.
|
||
* qsort: (libc)Array Sort Function.
|
||
* raise: (libc)Signaling Yourself.
|
||
* rand: (libc)ISO Random.
|
||
* rand_r: (libc)ISO Random.
|
||
* random: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* random_r: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* rawmemchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* read: (libc)I/O Primitives.
|
||
* readdir64: (libc)Reading/Closing Directory.
|
||
* readdir64_r: (libc)Reading/Closing Directory.
|
||
* readdir: (libc)Reading/Closing Directory.
|
||
* readdir_r: (libc)Reading/Closing Directory.
|
||
* readlink: (libc)Symbolic Links.
|
||
* readv: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* realloc: (libc)Changing Block Size.
|
||
* reallocarray: (libc)Changing Block Size.
|
||
* realpath: (libc)Symbolic Links.
|
||
* recv: (libc)Receiving Data.
|
||
* recvfrom: (libc)Receiving Datagrams.
|
||
* recvmsg: (libc)Receiving Datagrams.
|
||
* regcomp: (libc)POSIX Regexp Compilation.
|
||
* regerror: (libc)Regexp Cleanup.
|
||
* regexec: (libc)Matching POSIX Regexps.
|
||
* regfree: (libc)Regexp Cleanup.
|
||
* register_printf_function: (libc)Registering New Conversions.
|
||
* remainder: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* remainderf: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* remainderfN: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* remainderfNx: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* remainderl: (libc)Remainder Functions.
|
||
* remove: (libc)Deleting Files.
|
||
* rename: (libc)Renaming Files.
|
||
* rewind: (libc)File Positioning.
|
||
* rewinddir: (libc)Random Access Directory.
|
||
* rindex: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* rint: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* rintf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* rintfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* rintfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* rintl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* rmdir: (libc)Deleting Files.
|
||
* round: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundeven: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundevenf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundevenfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundevenfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundevenl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* roundl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* rpmatch: (libc)Yes-or-No Questions.
|
||
* sbrk: (libc)Resizing the Data Segment.
|
||
* scalb: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbf: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbl: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbln: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalblnf: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalblnfN: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalblnfNx: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalblnl: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbn: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbnf: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbnfN: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbnfNx: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scalbnl: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* scandir64: (libc)Scanning Directory Content.
|
||
* scandir: (libc)Scanning Directory Content.
|
||
* scanf: (libc)Formatted Input Functions.
|
||
* sched_get_priority_max: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_get_priority_min: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_getaffinity: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* sched_getparam: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_getscheduler: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_rr_get_interval: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_setaffinity: (libc)CPU Affinity.
|
||
* sched_setparam: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_setscheduler: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* sched_yield: (libc)Basic Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* secure_getenv: (libc)Environment Access.
|
||
* seed48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* seed48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* seekdir: (libc)Random Access Directory.
|
||
* select: (libc)Waiting for I/O.
|
||
* sem_clockwait: (libc)Waiting with Explicit Clocks.
|
||
* sem_close: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_destroy: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_getvalue: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_init: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_open: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_post: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_timedwait: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_trywait: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_unlink: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* sem_wait: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* semctl: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* semget: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* semop: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* semtimedop: (libc)Semaphores.
|
||
* send: (libc)Sending Data.
|
||
* sendmsg: (libc)Receiving Datagrams.
|
||
* sendto: (libc)Sending Datagrams.
|
||
* setbuf: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* setbuffer: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* setcontext: (libc)System V contexts.
|
||
* setdomainname: (libc)Host Identification.
|
||
* setegid: (libc)Setting Groups.
|
||
* setenv: (libc)Environment Access.
|
||
* seteuid: (libc)Setting User ID.
|
||
* setfsent: (libc)fstab.
|
||
* setgid: (libc)Setting Groups.
|
||
* setgrent: (libc)Scanning All Groups.
|
||
* setgroups: (libc)Setting Groups.
|
||
* sethostent: (libc)Host Names.
|
||
* sethostid: (libc)Host Identification.
|
||
* sethostname: (libc)Host Identification.
|
||
* setitimer: (libc)Setting an Alarm.
|
||
* setjmp: (libc)Non-Local Details.
|
||
* setlinebuf: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* setlocale: (libc)Setting the Locale.
|
||
* setlogmask: (libc)setlogmask.
|
||
* setmntent: (libc)mtab.
|
||
* setnetent: (libc)Networks Database.
|
||
* setnetgrent: (libc)Lookup Netgroup.
|
||
* setpayload: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadsig: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadsigf: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadsigfN: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadsigfNx: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpayloadsigl: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* setpgid: (libc)Process Group Functions.
|
||
* setpgrp: (libc)Process Group Functions.
|
||
* setpriority: (libc)Traditional Scheduling Functions.
|
||
* setprotoent: (libc)Protocols Database.
|
||
* setpwent: (libc)Scanning All Users.
|
||
* setregid: (libc)Setting Groups.
|
||
* setreuid: (libc)Setting User ID.
|
||
* setrlimit64: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* setrlimit: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* setservent: (libc)Services Database.
|
||
* setsid: (libc)Process Group Functions.
|
||
* setsockopt: (libc)Socket Option Functions.
|
||
* setstate: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* setstate_r: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* settimeofday: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* setuid: (libc)Setting User ID.
|
||
* setutent: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* setutxent: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* setvbuf: (libc)Controlling Buffering.
|
||
* shm_open: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* shm_unlink: (libc)Memory-mapped I/O.
|
||
* shutdown: (libc)Closing a Socket.
|
||
* sigabbrev_np: (libc)Signal Messages.
|
||
* sigaction: (libc)Advanced Signal Handling.
|
||
* sigaddset: (libc)Signal Sets.
|
||
* sigaltstack: (libc)Signal Stack.
|
||
* sigblock: (libc)BSD Signal Handling.
|
||
* sigdelset: (libc)Signal Sets.
|
||
* sigdescr_np: (libc)Signal Messages.
|
||
* sigemptyset: (libc)Signal Sets.
|
||
* sigfillset: (libc)Signal Sets.
|
||
* siginterrupt: (libc)BSD Signal Handling.
|
||
* sigismember: (libc)Signal Sets.
|
||
* siglongjmp: (libc)Non-Local Exits and Signals.
|
||
* sigmask: (libc)BSD Signal Handling.
|
||
* signal: (libc)Basic Signal Handling.
|
||
* signbit: (libc)FP Bit Twiddling.
|
||
* significand: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* significandf: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* significandl: (libc)Normalization Functions.
|
||
* sigpause: (libc)BSD Signal Handling.
|
||
* sigpending: (libc)Checking for Pending Signals.
|
||
* sigprocmask: (libc)Process Signal Mask.
|
||
* sigsetjmp: (libc)Non-Local Exits and Signals.
|
||
* sigsetmask: (libc)BSD Signal Handling.
|
||
* sigstack: (libc)Signal Stack.
|
||
* sigsuspend: (libc)Sigsuspend.
|
||
* sin: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sincos: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sincosf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sincosfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sincosfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sincosl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sinf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sinfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sinfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sinh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* sinhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* sinhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* sinhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* sinhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* sinl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* sleep: (libc)Sleeping.
|
||
* snprintf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* socket: (libc)Creating a Socket.
|
||
* socketpair: (libc)Socket Pairs.
|
||
* sprintf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* sqrt: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* sqrtf: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* sqrtfN: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* sqrtfNx: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* sqrtl: (libc)Exponents and Logarithms.
|
||
* srand48: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* srand48_r: (libc)SVID Random.
|
||
* srand: (libc)ISO Random.
|
||
* srandom: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* srandom_r: (libc)BSD Random.
|
||
* sscanf: (libc)Formatted Input Functions.
|
||
* ssignal: (libc)Basic Signal Handling.
|
||
* stat64: (libc)Reading Attributes.
|
||
* stat: (libc)Reading Attributes.
|
||
* stime: (libc)Setting and Adjusting the Time.
|
||
* stpcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* stpncpy: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* strcasecmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* strcasestr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strcat: (libc)Concatenating Strings.
|
||
* strchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strchrnul: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strcmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* strcoll: (libc)Collation Functions.
|
||
* strcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* strcspn: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strdup: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* strdupa: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* strerror: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* strerror_r: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* strerrordesc_np: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* strerrorname_np: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* strfmon: (libc)Formatting Numbers.
|
||
* strfromd: (libc)Printing of Floats.
|
||
* strfromf: (libc)Printing of Floats.
|
||
* strfromfN: (libc)Printing of Floats.
|
||
* strfromfNx: (libc)Printing of Floats.
|
||
* strfroml: (libc)Printing of Floats.
|
||
* strfry: (libc)Shuffling Bytes.
|
||
* strftime: (libc)Formatting Calendar Time.
|
||
* strlen: (libc)String Length.
|
||
* strncasecmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* strncat: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* strncmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* strncpy: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* strndup: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* strndupa: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* strnlen: (libc)String Length.
|
||
* strpbrk: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strptime: (libc)Low-Level Time String Parsing.
|
||
* strrchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strsep: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* strsignal: (libc)Signal Messages.
|
||
* strspn: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strstr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* strtod: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* strtof: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* strtofN: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* strtofNx: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* strtoimax: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtok: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* strtok_r: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* strtol: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtold: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* strtoll: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtoq: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtoul: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtoull: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtoumax: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strtouq: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* strverscmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* strxfrm: (libc)Collation Functions.
|
||
* stty: (libc)BSD Terminal Modes.
|
||
* swapcontext: (libc)System V contexts.
|
||
* swprintf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* swscanf: (libc)Formatted Input Functions.
|
||
* symlink: (libc)Symbolic Links.
|
||
* sync: (libc)Synchronizing I/O.
|
||
* syscall: (libc)System Calls.
|
||
* sysconf: (libc)Sysconf Definition.
|
||
* syslog: (libc)syslog; vsyslog.
|
||
* system: (libc)Running a Command.
|
||
* sysv_signal: (libc)Basic Signal Handling.
|
||
* tan: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* tanf: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* tanfN: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* tanfNx: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* tanh: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* tanhf: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* tanhfN: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* tanhfNx: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* tanhl: (libc)Hyperbolic Functions.
|
||
* tanl: (libc)Trig Functions.
|
||
* tcdrain: (libc)Line Control.
|
||
* tcflow: (libc)Line Control.
|
||
* tcflush: (libc)Line Control.
|
||
* tcgetattr: (libc)Mode Functions.
|
||
* tcgetpgrp: (libc)Terminal Access Functions.
|
||
* tcgetsid: (libc)Terminal Access Functions.
|
||
* tcsendbreak: (libc)Line Control.
|
||
* tcsetattr: (libc)Mode Functions.
|
||
* tcsetpgrp: (libc)Terminal Access Functions.
|
||
* tdelete: (libc)Tree Search Function.
|
||
* tdestroy: (libc)Tree Search Function.
|
||
* telldir: (libc)Random Access Directory.
|
||
* tempnam: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* textdomain: (libc)Locating gettext catalog.
|
||
* tfind: (libc)Tree Search Function.
|
||
* tgamma: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* tgammaf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* tgammafN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* tgammafNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* tgammal: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* tgkill: (libc)Signaling Another Process.
|
||
* thrd_create: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_current: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_detach: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_equal: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_exit: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_join: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_sleep: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* thrd_yield: (libc)ISO C Thread Management.
|
||
* time: (libc)Getting the Time.
|
||
* timegm: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* timelocal: (libc)Broken-down Time.
|
||
* times: (libc)Processor Time.
|
||
* tmpfile64: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* tmpfile: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* tmpnam: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* tmpnam_r: (libc)Temporary Files.
|
||
* toascii: (libc)Case Conversion.
|
||
* tolower: (libc)Case Conversion.
|
||
* totalorder: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalorderf: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalorderfN: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalorderfNx: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalorderl: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalordermag: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalordermagf: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalordermagfN: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalordermagfNx: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* totalordermagl: (libc)FP Comparison Functions.
|
||
* toupper: (libc)Case Conversion.
|
||
* towctrans: (libc)Wide Character Case Conversion.
|
||
* towlower: (libc)Wide Character Case Conversion.
|
||
* towupper: (libc)Wide Character Case Conversion.
|
||
* trunc: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* truncate64: (libc)File Size.
|
||
* truncate: (libc)File Size.
|
||
* truncf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* truncfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* truncfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* truncl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* tsearch: (libc)Tree Search Function.
|
||
* tss_create: (libc)ISO C Thread-local Storage.
|
||
* tss_delete: (libc)ISO C Thread-local Storage.
|
||
* tss_get: (libc)ISO C Thread-local Storage.
|
||
* tss_set: (libc)ISO C Thread-local Storage.
|
||
* ttyname: (libc)Is It a Terminal.
|
||
* ttyname_r: (libc)Is It a Terminal.
|
||
* twalk: (libc)Tree Search Function.
|
||
* twalk_r: (libc)Tree Search Function.
|
||
* tzset: (libc)Time Zone Functions.
|
||
* ufromfp: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpxf: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpxfN: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpxfNx: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ufromfpxl: (libc)Rounding Functions.
|
||
* ulimit: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* umask: (libc)Setting Permissions.
|
||
* umount2: (libc)Mount-Unmount-Remount.
|
||
* umount: (libc)Mount-Unmount-Remount.
|
||
* uname: (libc)Platform Type.
|
||
* ungetc: (libc)How Unread.
|
||
* ungetwc: (libc)How Unread.
|
||
* unlink: (libc)Deleting Files.
|
||
* unlockpt: (libc)Allocation.
|
||
* unsetenv: (libc)Environment Access.
|
||
* updwtmp: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* utime: (libc)File Times.
|
||
* utimes: (libc)File Times.
|
||
* utmpname: (libc)Manipulating the Database.
|
||
* utmpxname: (libc)XPG Functions.
|
||
* va_arg: (libc)Argument Macros.
|
||
* va_copy: (libc)Argument Macros.
|
||
* va_end: (libc)Argument Macros.
|
||
* va_start: (libc)Argument Macros.
|
||
* valloc: (libc)Aligned Memory Blocks.
|
||
* vasprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* verr: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* verrx: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* versionsort64: (libc)Scanning Directory Content.
|
||
* versionsort: (libc)Scanning Directory Content.
|
||
* vfork: (libc)Creating a Process.
|
||
* vfprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vfscanf: (libc)Variable Arguments Input.
|
||
* vfwprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vfwscanf: (libc)Variable Arguments Input.
|
||
* vlimit: (libc)Limits on Resources.
|
||
* vprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vscanf: (libc)Variable Arguments Input.
|
||
* vsnprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vsprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vsscanf: (libc)Variable Arguments Input.
|
||
* vswprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vswscanf: (libc)Variable Arguments Input.
|
||
* vsyslog: (libc)syslog; vsyslog.
|
||
* vwarn: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* vwarnx: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* vwprintf: (libc)Variable Arguments Output.
|
||
* vwscanf: (libc)Variable Arguments Input.
|
||
* wait3: (libc)BSD Wait Functions.
|
||
* wait4: (libc)Process Completion.
|
||
* wait: (libc)Process Completion.
|
||
* waitpid: (libc)Process Completion.
|
||
* warn: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* warnx: (libc)Error Messages.
|
||
* wcpcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wcpncpy: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* wcrtomb: (libc)Converting a Character.
|
||
* wcscasecmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* wcscat: (libc)Concatenating Strings.
|
||
* wcschr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcschrnul: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcscmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* wcscoll: (libc)Collation Functions.
|
||
* wcscpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wcscspn: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcsdup: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wcsftime: (libc)Formatting Calendar Time.
|
||
* wcslen: (libc)String Length.
|
||
* wcsncasecmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* wcsncat: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* wcsncmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* wcsncpy: (libc)Truncating Strings.
|
||
* wcsnlen: (libc)String Length.
|
||
* wcsnrtombs: (libc)Converting Strings.
|
||
* wcspbrk: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcsrchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcsrtombs: (libc)Converting Strings.
|
||
* wcsspn: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcsstr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcstod: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* wcstof: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* wcstofN: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* wcstofNx: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* wcstoimax: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstok: (libc)Finding Tokens in a String.
|
||
* wcstol: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstold: (libc)Parsing of Floats.
|
||
* wcstoll: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstombs: (libc)Non-reentrant String Conversion.
|
||
* wcstoq: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstoul: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstoull: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstoumax: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcstouq: (libc)Parsing of Integers.
|
||
* wcswcs: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wcsxfrm: (libc)Collation Functions.
|
||
* wctob: (libc)Converting a Character.
|
||
* wctomb: (libc)Non-reentrant Character Conversion.
|
||
* wctrans: (libc)Wide Character Case Conversion.
|
||
* wctype: (libc)Classification of Wide Characters.
|
||
* wmemchr: (libc)Search Functions.
|
||
* wmemcmp: (libc)String/Array Comparison.
|
||
* wmemcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wmemmove: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wmempcpy: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wmemset: (libc)Copying Strings and Arrays.
|
||
* wordexp: (libc)Calling Wordexp.
|
||
* wordfree: (libc)Calling Wordexp.
|
||
* wprintf: (libc)Formatted Output Functions.
|
||
* write: (libc)I/O Primitives.
|
||
* writev: (libc)Scatter-Gather.
|
||
* wscanf: (libc)Formatted Input Functions.
|
||
* y0: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y0f: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y0fN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y0fNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y0l: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y1: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y1f: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y1fN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y1fNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* y1l: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* yn: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* ynf: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* ynfN: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* ynfNx: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
* ynl: (libc)Special Functions.
|
||
END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Process Completion Status, Next: BSD Wait Functions, Prev: Process Completion, Up: Processes
|
||
|
||
26.7 Process Completion Status
|
||
==============================
|
||
|
||
If the exit status value (*note Program Termination::) of the child
|
||
process is zero, then the status value reported by ‘waitpid’ or ‘wait’
|
||
is also zero. You can test for other kinds of information encoded in
|
||
the returned status value using the following macros. These macros are
|
||
defined in the header file ‘sys/wait.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WIFEXITED (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This macro returns a nonzero value if the child process terminated
|
||
normally with ‘exit’ or ‘_exit’.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WEXITSTATUS (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
If ‘WIFEXITED’ is true of STATUS, this macro returns the low-order
|
||
8 bits of the exit status value from the child process. *Note Exit
|
||
Status::.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WIFSIGNALED (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This macro returns a nonzero value if the child process terminated
|
||
because it received a signal that was not handled. *Note Signal
|
||
Handling::.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WTERMSIG (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
If ‘WIFSIGNALED’ is true of STATUS, this macro returns the signal
|
||
number of the signal that terminated the child process.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WCOREDUMP (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This macro returns a nonzero value if the child process terminated
|
||
and produced a core dump.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WIFSTOPPED (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This macro returns a nonzero value if the child process is stopped.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int WSTOPSIG (int STATUS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
If ‘WIFSTOPPED’ is true of STATUS, this macro returns the signal
|
||
number of the signal that caused the child process to stop.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: BSD Wait Functions, Next: Process Creation Example, Prev: Process Completion Status, Up: Processes
|
||
|
||
26.8 BSD Process Wait Function
|
||
==============================
|
||
|
||
The GNU C Library also provides the ‘wait3’ function for compatibility
|
||
with BSD. This function is declared in ‘sys/wait.h’. It is the
|
||
predecessor to ‘wait4’, which is more flexible. ‘wait3’ is now
|
||
obsolete.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: pid_t wait3 (int *STATUS-PTR, int OPTIONS, struct rusage
|
||
*USAGE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
If USAGE is a null pointer, ‘wait3’ is equivalent to ‘waitpid (-1,
|
||
STATUS-PTR, OPTIONS)’.
|
||
|
||
If USAGE is not null, ‘wait3’ stores usage figures for the child
|
||
process in ‘*RUSAGE’ (but only if the child has terminated, not if
|
||
it has stopped). *Note Resource Usage::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Process Creation Example, Prev: BSD Wait Functions, Up: Processes
|
||
|
||
26.9 Process Creation Example
|
||
=============================
|
||
|
||
Here is an example program showing how you might write a function
|
||
similar to the built-in ‘system’. It executes its COMMAND argument
|
||
using the equivalent of ‘sh -c COMMAND’.
|
||
|
||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||
|
||
/* Execute the command using this shell program. */
|
||
#define SHELL "/bin/sh"
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
my_system (const char *command)
|
||
{
|
||
int status;
|
||
pid_t pid;
|
||
|
||
pid = fork ();
|
||
if (pid == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is the child process. Execute the shell command. */
|
||
execl (SHELL, SHELL, "-c", command, NULL);
|
||
_exit (EXIT_FAILURE);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (pid < 0)
|
||
/* The fork failed. Report failure. */
|
||
status = -1;
|
||
else
|
||
/* This is the parent process. Wait for the child to complete. */
|
||
if (waitpid (pid, &status, 0) != pid)
|
||
status = -1;
|
||
return status;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
There are a couple of things you should pay attention to in this
|
||
example.
|
||
|
||
Remember that the first ‘argv’ argument supplied to the program
|
||
represents the name of the program being executed. That is why, in the
|
||
call to ‘execl’, ‘SHELL’ is supplied once to name the program to execute
|
||
and a second time to supply a value for ‘argv[0]’.
|
||
|
||
The ‘execl’ call in the child process doesn’t return if it is
|
||
successful. If it fails, you must do something to make the child
|
||
process terminate. Just returning a bad status code with ‘return’ would
|
||
leave two processes running the original program. Instead, the right
|
||
behavior is for the child process to report failure to its parent
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
Call ‘_exit’ to accomplish this. The reason for using ‘_exit’
|
||
instead of ‘exit’ is to avoid flushing fully buffered streams such as
|
||
‘stdout’. The buffers of these streams probably contain data that was
|
||
copied from the parent process by the ‘fork’, data that will be output
|
||
eventually by the parent process. Calling ‘exit’ in the child would
|
||
output the data twice. *Note Termination Internals::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Inter-Process Communication, Next: Job Control, Prev: Processes, Up: Top
|
||
|
||
27 Inter-Process Communication
|
||
******************************
|
||
|
||
This chapter describes the GNU C Library inter-process communication
|
||
primitives.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Semaphores:: Support for creating and managing semaphores
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Semaphores, Up: Inter-Process Communication
|
||
|
||
27.1 Semaphores
|
||
===============
|
||
|
||
The GNU C Library implements the semaphore APIs as defined in POSIX and
|
||
System V. Semaphores can be used by multiple processes to coordinate
|
||
shared resources. The following is a complete list of the semaphore
|
||
functions provided by the GNU C Library.
|
||
|
||
27.1.1 System V Semaphores
|
||
--------------------------
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int semctl (int SEMID, int SEMNUM, int CMD);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Unsafe corrupt/linux | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int semget (key_t KEY, int NSEMS, int SEMFLG);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int semop (int SEMID, struct sembuf *SOPS, size_t NSOPS);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int semtimedop (int SEMID, struct sembuf *SOPS, size_t
|
||
NSOPS, const struct timespec *TIMEOUT);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
27.1.2 POSIX Semaphores
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_init (sem_t *SEM, int PSHARED, unsigned int
|
||
VALUE);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Unsafe corrupt | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_destroy (sem_t *SEM);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: sem_t *sem_open (const char *NAME, int OFLAG, ...);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe init | AC-Unsafe init | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_close (sem_t *SEM);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_unlink (const char *NAME);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe init | AC-Unsafe corrupt | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_wait (sem_t *SEM);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Unsafe corrupt | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_timedwait (sem_t *SEM, const struct timespec
|
||
*ABSTIME);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Unsafe corrupt | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_trywait (sem_t *SEM);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_post (sem_t *SEM);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sem_getvalue (sem_t *SEM, int *SVAL);
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Job Control, Next: Name Service Switch, Prev: Inter-Process Communication, Up: Top
|
||
|
||
28 Job Control
|
||
**************
|
||
|
||
"Job control" refers to the protocol for allowing a user to move between
|
||
multiple "process groups" (or "jobs") within a single "login session".
|
||
The job control facilities are set up so that appropriate behavior for
|
||
most programs happens automatically and they need not do anything
|
||
special about job control. So you can probably ignore the material in
|
||
this chapter unless you are writing a shell or login program.
|
||
|
||
You need to be familiar with concepts relating to process creation
|
||
(*note Process Creation Concepts::) and signal handling (*note Signal
|
||
Handling::) in order to understand this material presented in this
|
||
chapter.
|
||
|
||
Some old systems do not support job control, but GNU systems always
|
||
have, and it is a required feature in the 2001 revision of POSIX.1
|
||
(*note POSIX::). If you need to be portable to old systems, you can use
|
||
the ‘_POSIX_JOB_CONTROL’ macro to test at compile-time whether the
|
||
system supports job control. *Note System Options::.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Concepts of Job Control:: Jobs can be controlled by a shell.
|
||
* Controlling Terminal:: How a process gets its controlling terminal.
|
||
* Access to the Terminal:: How processes share the controlling terminal.
|
||
* Orphaned Process Groups:: Jobs left after the user logs out.
|
||
* Implementing a Shell:: What a shell must do to implement job control.
|
||
* Functions for Job Control:: Functions to control process groups.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Concepts of Job Control, Next: Controlling Terminal, Up: Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.1 Concepts of Job Control
|
||
============================
|
||
|
||
The fundamental purpose of an interactive shell is to read commands from
|
||
the user’s terminal and create processes to execute the programs
|
||
specified by those commands. It can do this using the ‘fork’ (*note
|
||
Creating a Process::) and ‘exec’ (*note Executing a File::) functions.
|
||
|
||
A single command may run just one process—but often one command uses
|
||
several processes. If you use the ‘|’ operator in a shell command, you
|
||
explicitly request several programs in their own processes. But even if
|
||
you run just one program, it can use multiple processes internally. For
|
||
example, a single compilation command such as ‘cc -c foo.c’ typically
|
||
uses four processes (though normally only two at any given time). If
|
||
you run ‘make’, its job is to run other programs in separate processes.
|
||
|
||
The processes belonging to a single command are called a "process
|
||
group" or "job". This is so that you can operate on all of them at
|
||
once. For example, typing ‘C-c’ sends the signal ‘SIGINT’ to terminate
|
||
all the processes in the foreground process group.
|
||
|
||
A "session" is a larger group of processes. Normally all the
|
||
processes that stem from a single login belong to the same session.
|
||
|
||
Every process belongs to a process group. When a process is created,
|
||
it becomes a member of the same process group and session as its parent
|
||
process. You can put it in another process group using the ‘setpgid’
|
||
function, provided the process group belongs to the same session.
|
||
|
||
The only way to put a process in a different session is to make it
|
||
the initial process of a new session, or a "session leader", using the
|
||
‘setsid’ function. This also puts the session leader into a new process
|
||
group, and you can’t move it out of that process group again.
|
||
|
||
Usually, new sessions are created by the system login program, and
|
||
the session leader is the process running the user’s login shell.
|
||
|
||
A shell that supports job control must arrange to control which job
|
||
can use the terminal at any time. Otherwise there might be multiple
|
||
jobs trying to read from the terminal at once, and confusion about which
|
||
process should receive the input typed by the user. To prevent this,
|
||
the shell must cooperate with the terminal driver using the protocol
|
||
described in this chapter.
|
||
|
||
The shell can give unlimited access to the controlling terminal to
|
||
only one process group at a time. This is called the "foreground job"
|
||
on that controlling terminal. Other process groups managed by the shell
|
||
that are executing without such access to the terminal are called
|
||
"background jobs".
|
||
|
||
If a background job needs to read from its controlling terminal, it
|
||
is "stopped" by the terminal driver; if the ‘TOSTOP’ mode is set,
|
||
likewise for writing. The user can stop a foreground job by typing the
|
||
SUSP character (*note Special Characters::) and a program can stop any
|
||
job by sending it a ‘SIGSTOP’ signal. It’s the responsibility of the
|
||
shell to notice when jobs stop, to notify the user about them, and to
|
||
provide mechanisms for allowing the user to interactively continue
|
||
stopped jobs and switch jobs between foreground and background.
|
||
|
||
*Note Access to the Terminal::, for more information about I/O to the
|
||
controlling terminal.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Controlling Terminal, Next: Access to the Terminal, Prev: Concepts of Job Control, Up: Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.2 Controlling Terminal of a Process
|
||
======================================
|
||
|
||
One of the attributes of a process is its controlling terminal. Child
|
||
processes created with ‘fork’ inherit the controlling terminal from
|
||
their parent process. In this way, all the processes in a session
|
||
inherit the controlling terminal from the session leader. A session
|
||
leader that has control of a terminal is called the "controlling
|
||
process" of that terminal.
|
||
|
||
You generally do not need to worry about the exact mechanism used to
|
||
allocate a controlling terminal to a session, since it is done for you
|
||
by the system when you log in.
|
||
|
||
An individual process disconnects from its controlling terminal when
|
||
it calls ‘setsid’ to become the leader of a new session. *Note Process
|
||
Group Functions::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Access to the Terminal, Next: Orphaned Process Groups, Prev: Controlling Terminal, Up: Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.3 Access to the Controlling Terminal
|
||
=======================================
|
||
|
||
Processes in the foreground job of a controlling terminal have
|
||
unrestricted access to that terminal; background processes do not. This
|
||
section describes in more detail what happens when a process in a
|
||
background job tries to access its controlling terminal.
|
||
|
||
When a process in a background job tries to read from its controlling
|
||
terminal, the process group is usually sent a ‘SIGTTIN’ signal. This
|
||
normally causes all of the processes in that group to stop (unless they
|
||
handle the signal and don’t stop themselves). However, if the reading
|
||
process is ignoring or blocking this signal, then ‘read’ fails with an
|
||
‘EIO’ error instead.
|
||
|
||
Similarly, when a process in a background job tries to write to its
|
||
controlling terminal, the default behavior is to send a ‘SIGTTOU’ signal
|
||
to the process group. However, the behavior is modified by the ‘TOSTOP’
|
||
bit of the local modes flags (*note Local Modes::). If this bit is not
|
||
set (which is the default), then writing to the controlling terminal is
|
||
always permitted without sending a signal. Writing is also permitted if
|
||
the ‘SIGTTOU’ signal is being ignored or blocked by the writing process.
|
||
|
||
Most other terminal operations that a program can do are treated as
|
||
reading or as writing. (The description of each operation should say
|
||
which.)
|
||
|
||
For more information about the primitive ‘read’ and ‘write’
|
||
functions, see *note I/O Primitives::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Orphaned Process Groups, Next: Implementing a Shell, Prev: Access to the Terminal, Up: Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.4 Orphaned Process Groups
|
||
============================
|
||
|
||
When a controlling process terminates, its terminal becomes free and a
|
||
new session can be established on it. (In fact, another user could log
|
||
in on the terminal.) This could cause a problem if any processes from
|
||
the old session are still trying to use that terminal.
|
||
|
||
To prevent problems, process groups that continue running even after
|
||
the session leader has terminated are marked as "orphaned process
|
||
groups".
|
||
|
||
When a process group becomes an orphan, its processes are sent a
|
||
‘SIGHUP’ signal. Ordinarily, this causes the processes to terminate.
|
||
However, if a program ignores this signal or establishes a handler for
|
||
it (*note Signal Handling::), it can continue running as in the orphan
|
||
process group even after its controlling process terminates; but it
|
||
still cannot access the terminal any more.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Implementing a Shell, Next: Functions for Job Control, Prev: Orphaned Process Groups, Up: Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.5 Implementing a Job Control Shell
|
||
=====================================
|
||
|
||
This section describes what a shell must do to implement job control, by
|
||
presenting an extensive sample program to illustrate the concepts
|
||
involved.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Data Structures:: Introduction to the sample shell.
|
||
* Initializing the Shell:: What the shell must do to take
|
||
responsibility for job control.
|
||
* Launching Jobs:: Creating jobs to execute commands.
|
||
* Foreground and Background:: Putting a job in foreground of background.
|
||
* Stopped and Terminated Jobs:: Reporting job status.
|
||
* Continuing Stopped Jobs:: How to continue a stopped job in
|
||
the foreground or background.
|
||
* Missing Pieces:: Other parts of the shell.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Data Structures, Next: Initializing the Shell, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.1 Data Structures for the Shell
|
||
------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
All of the program examples included in this chapter are part of a
|
||
simple shell program. This section presents data structures and utility
|
||
functions which are used throughout the example.
|
||
|
||
The sample shell deals mainly with two data structures. The ‘job’
|
||
type contains information about a job, which is a set of subprocesses
|
||
linked together with pipes. The ‘process’ type holds information about
|
||
a single subprocess. Here are the relevant data structure declarations:
|
||
|
||
/* A process is a single process. */
|
||
typedef struct process
|
||
{
|
||
struct process *next; /* next process in pipeline */
|
||
char **argv; /* for exec */
|
||
pid_t pid; /* process ID */
|
||
char completed; /* true if process has completed */
|
||
char stopped; /* true if process has stopped */
|
||
int status; /* reported status value */
|
||
} process;
|
||
|
||
/* A job is a pipeline of processes. */
|
||
typedef struct job
|
||
{
|
||
struct job *next; /* next active job */
|
||
char *command; /* command line, used for messages */
|
||
process *first_process; /* list of processes in this job */
|
||
pid_t pgid; /* process group ID */
|
||
char notified; /* true if user told about stopped job */
|
||
struct termios tmodes; /* saved terminal modes */
|
||
int stdin, stdout, stderr; /* standard i/o channels */
|
||
} job;
|
||
|
||
/* The active jobs are linked into a list. This is its head. */
|
||
job *first_job = NULL;
|
||
|
||
Here are some utility functions that are used for operating on ‘job’
|
||
objects.
|
||
|
||
/* Find the active job with the indicated PGID. */
|
||
job *
|
||
find_job (pid_t pgid)
|
||
{
|
||
job *j;
|
||
|
||
for (j = first_job; j; j = j->next)
|
||
if (j->pgid == pgid)
|
||
return j;
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return true if all processes in the job have stopped or completed. */
|
||
int
|
||
job_is_stopped (job *j)
|
||
{
|
||
process *p;
|
||
|
||
for (p = j->first_process; p; p = p->next)
|
||
if (!p->completed && !p->stopped)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return true if all processes in the job have completed. */
|
||
int
|
||
job_is_completed (job *j)
|
||
{
|
||
process *p;
|
||
|
||
for (p = j->first_process; p; p = p->next)
|
||
if (!p->completed)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Initializing the Shell, Next: Launching Jobs, Prev: Data Structures, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.2 Initializing the Shell
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
When a shell program that normally performs job control is started, it
|
||
has to be careful in case it has been invoked from another shell that is
|
||
already doing its own job control.
|
||
|
||
A subshell that runs interactively has to ensure that it has been
|
||
placed in the foreground by its parent shell before it can enable job
|
||
control itself. It does this by getting its initial process group ID
|
||
with the ‘getpgrp’ function, and comparing it to the process group ID of
|
||
the current foreground job associated with its controlling terminal
|
||
(which can be retrieved using the ‘tcgetpgrp’ function).
|
||
|
||
If the subshell is not running as a foreground job, it must stop
|
||
itself by sending a ‘SIGTTIN’ signal to its own process group. It may
|
||
not arbitrarily put itself into the foreground; it must wait for the
|
||
user to tell the parent shell to do this. If the subshell is continued
|
||
again, it should repeat the check and stop itself again if it is still
|
||
not in the foreground.
|
||
|
||
Once the subshell has been placed into the foreground by its parent
|
||
shell, it can enable its own job control. It does this by calling
|
||
‘setpgid’ to put itself into its own process group, and then calling
|
||
‘tcsetpgrp’ to place this process group into the foreground.
|
||
|
||
When a shell enables job control, it should set itself to ignore all
|
||
the job control stop signals so that it doesn’t accidentally stop
|
||
itself. You can do this by setting the action for all the stop signals
|
||
to ‘SIG_IGN’.
|
||
|
||
A subshell that runs non-interactively cannot and should not support
|
||
job control. It must leave all processes it creates in the same process
|
||
group as the shell itself; this allows the non-interactive shell and its
|
||
child processes to be treated as a single job by the parent shell. This
|
||
is easy to do—just don’t use any of the job control primitives—but you
|
||
must remember to make the shell do it.
|
||
|
||
Here is the initialization code for the sample shell that shows how
|
||
to do all of this.
|
||
|
||
/* Keep track of attributes of the shell. */
|
||
|
||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||
#include <termios.h>
|
||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||
|
||
pid_t shell_pgid;
|
||
struct termios shell_tmodes;
|
||
int shell_terminal;
|
||
int shell_is_interactive;
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure the shell is running interactively as the foreground job
|
||
before proceeding. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
init_shell ()
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
/* See if we are running interactively. */
|
||
shell_terminal = STDIN_FILENO;
|
||
shell_is_interactive = isatty (shell_terminal);
|
||
|
||
if (shell_is_interactive)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Loop until we are in the foreground. */
|
||
while (tcgetpgrp (shell_terminal) != (shell_pgid = getpgrp ()))
|
||
kill (- shell_pgid, SIGTTIN);
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore interactive and job-control signals. */
|
||
signal (SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
|
||
signal (SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
|
||
signal (SIGTSTP, SIG_IGN);
|
||
signal (SIGTTIN, SIG_IGN);
|
||
signal (SIGTTOU, SIG_IGN);
|
||
signal (SIGCHLD, SIG_IGN);
|
||
|
||
/* Put ourselves in our own process group. */
|
||
shell_pgid = getpid ();
|
||
if (setpgid (shell_pgid, shell_pgid) < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
perror ("Couldn't put the shell in its own process group");
|
||
exit (1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Grab control of the terminal. */
|
||
tcsetpgrp (shell_terminal, shell_pgid);
|
||
|
||
/* Save default terminal attributes for shell. */
|
||
tcgetattr (shell_terminal, &shell_tmodes);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Launching Jobs, Next: Foreground and Background, Prev: Initializing the Shell, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.3 Launching Jobs
|
||
---------------------
|
||
|
||
Once the shell has taken responsibility for performing job control on
|
||
its controlling terminal, it can launch jobs in response to commands
|
||
typed by the user.
|
||
|
||
To create the processes in a process group, you use the same ‘fork’
|
||
and ‘exec’ functions described in *note Process Creation Concepts::.
|
||
Since there are multiple child processes involved, though, things are a
|
||
little more complicated and you must be careful to do things in the
|
||
right order. Otherwise, nasty race conditions can result.
|
||
|
||
You have two choices for how to structure the tree of parent-child
|
||
relationships among the processes. You can either make all the
|
||
processes in the process group be children of the shell process, or you
|
||
can make one process in group be the ancestor of all the other processes
|
||
in that group. The sample shell program presented in this chapter uses
|
||
the first approach because it makes bookkeeping somewhat simpler.
|
||
|
||
As each process is forked, it should put itself in the new process
|
||
group by calling ‘setpgid’; see *note Process Group Functions::. The
|
||
first process in the new group becomes its "process group leader", and
|
||
its process ID becomes the "process group ID" for the group.
|
||
|
||
The shell should also call ‘setpgid’ to put each of its child
|
||
processes into the new process group. This is because there is a
|
||
potential timing problem: each child process must be put in the process
|
||
group before it begins executing a new program, and the shell depends on
|
||
having all the child processes in the group before it continues
|
||
executing. If both the child processes and the shell call ‘setpgid’,
|
||
this ensures that the right things happen no matter which process gets
|
||
to it first.
|
||
|
||
If the job is being launched as a foreground job, the new process
|
||
group also needs to be put into the foreground on the controlling
|
||
terminal using ‘tcsetpgrp’. Again, this should be done by the shell as
|
||
well as by each of its child processes, to avoid race conditions.
|
||
|
||
The next thing each child process should do is to reset its signal
|
||
actions.
|
||
|
||
During initialization, the shell process set itself to ignore job
|
||
control signals; see *note Initializing the Shell::. As a result, any
|
||
child processes it creates also ignore these signals by inheritance.
|
||
This is definitely undesirable, so each child process should explicitly
|
||
set the actions for these signals back to ‘SIG_DFL’ just after it is
|
||
forked.
|
||
|
||
Since shells follow this convention, applications can assume that
|
||
they inherit the correct handling of these signals from the parent
|
||
process. But every application has a responsibility not to mess up the
|
||
handling of stop signals. Applications that disable the normal
|
||
interpretation of the SUSP character should provide some other mechanism
|
||
for the user to stop the job. When the user invokes this mechanism, the
|
||
program should send a ‘SIGTSTP’ signal to the process group of the
|
||
process, not just to the process itself. *Note Signaling Another
|
||
Process::.
|
||
|
||
Finally, each child process should call ‘exec’ in the normal way.
|
||
This is also the point at which redirection of the standard input and
|
||
output channels should be handled. *Note Duplicating Descriptors::, for
|
||
an explanation of how to do this.
|
||
|
||
Here is the function from the sample shell program that is
|
||
responsible for launching a program. The function is executed by each
|
||
child process immediately after it has been forked by the shell, and
|
||
never returns.
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
launch_process (process *p, pid_t pgid,
|
||
int infile, int outfile, int errfile,
|
||
int foreground)
|
||
{
|
||
pid_t pid;
|
||
|
||
if (shell_is_interactive)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Put the process into the process group and give the process group
|
||
the terminal, if appropriate.
|
||
This has to be done both by the shell and in the individual
|
||
child processes because of potential race conditions. */
|
||
pid = getpid ();
|
||
if (pgid == 0) pgid = pid;
|
||
setpgid (pid, pgid);
|
||
if (foreground)
|
||
tcsetpgrp (shell_terminal, pgid);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the handling for job control signals back to the default. */
|
||
signal (SIGINT, SIG_DFL);
|
||
signal (SIGQUIT, SIG_DFL);
|
||
signal (SIGTSTP, SIG_DFL);
|
||
signal (SIGTTIN, SIG_DFL);
|
||
signal (SIGTTOU, SIG_DFL);
|
||
signal (SIGCHLD, SIG_DFL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set the standard input/output channels of the new process. */
|
||
if (infile != STDIN_FILENO)
|
||
{
|
||
dup2 (infile, STDIN_FILENO);
|
||
close (infile);
|
||
}
|
||
if (outfile != STDOUT_FILENO)
|
||
{
|
||
dup2 (outfile, STDOUT_FILENO);
|
||
close (outfile);
|
||
}
|
||
if (errfile != STDERR_FILENO)
|
||
{
|
||
dup2 (errfile, STDERR_FILENO);
|
||
close (errfile);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Exec the new process. Make sure we exit. */
|
||
execvp (p->argv[0], p->argv);
|
||
perror ("execvp");
|
||
exit (1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
If the shell is not running interactively, this function does not do
|
||
anything with process groups or signals. Remember that a shell not
|
||
performing job control must keep all of its subprocesses in the same
|
||
process group as the shell itself.
|
||
|
||
Next, here is the function that actually launches a complete job.
|
||
After creating the child processes, this function calls some other
|
||
functions to put the newly created job into the foreground or
|
||
background; these are discussed in *note Foreground and Background::.
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
launch_job (job *j, int foreground)
|
||
{
|
||
process *p;
|
||
pid_t pid;
|
||
int mypipe[2], infile, outfile;
|
||
|
||
infile = j->stdin;
|
||
for (p = j->first_process; p; p = p->next)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set up pipes, if necessary. */
|
||
if (p->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (pipe (mypipe) < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
perror ("pipe");
|
||
exit (1);
|
||
}
|
||
outfile = mypipe[1];
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
outfile = j->stdout;
|
||
|
||
/* Fork the child processes. */
|
||
pid = fork ();
|
||
if (pid == 0)
|
||
/* This is the child process. */
|
||
launch_process (p, j->pgid, infile,
|
||
outfile, j->stderr, foreground);
|
||
else if (pid < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The fork failed. */
|
||
perror ("fork");
|
||
exit (1);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is the parent process. */
|
||
p->pid = pid;
|
||
if (shell_is_interactive)
|
||
{
|
||
if (!j->pgid)
|
||
j->pgid = pid;
|
||
setpgid (pid, j->pgid);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clean up after pipes. */
|
||
if (infile != j->stdin)
|
||
close (infile);
|
||
if (outfile != j->stdout)
|
||
close (outfile);
|
||
infile = mypipe[0];
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
format_job_info (j, "launched");
|
||
|
||
if (!shell_is_interactive)
|
||
wait_for_job (j);
|
||
else if (foreground)
|
||
put_job_in_foreground (j, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
put_job_in_background (j, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Foreground and Background, Next: Stopped and Terminated Jobs, Prev: Launching Jobs, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.4 Foreground and Background
|
||
--------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Now let’s consider what actions must be taken by the shell when it
|
||
launches a job into the foreground, and how this differs from what must
|
||
be done when a background job is launched.
|
||
|
||
When a foreground job is launched, the shell must first give it
|
||
access to the controlling terminal by calling ‘tcsetpgrp’. Then, the
|
||
shell should wait for processes in that process group to terminate or
|
||
stop. This is discussed in more detail in *note Stopped and Terminated
|
||
Jobs::.
|
||
|
||
When all of the processes in the group have either completed or
|
||
stopped, the shell should regain control of the terminal for its own
|
||
process group by calling ‘tcsetpgrp’ again. Since stop signals caused
|
||
by I/O from a background process or a SUSP character typed by the user
|
||
are sent to the process group, normally all the processes in the job
|
||
stop together.
|
||
|
||
The foreground job may have left the terminal in a strange state, so
|
||
the shell should restore its own saved terminal modes before continuing.
|
||
In case the job is merely stopped, the shell should first save the
|
||
current terminal modes so that it can restore them later if the job is
|
||
continued. The functions for dealing with terminal modes are
|
||
‘tcgetattr’ and ‘tcsetattr’; these are described in *note Terminal
|
||
Modes::.
|
||
|
||
Here is the sample shell’s function for doing all of this.
|
||
|
||
/* Put job J in the foreground. If CONT is nonzero,
|
||
restore the saved terminal modes and send the process group a
|
||
‘SIGCONT’ signal to wake it up before we block. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
put_job_in_foreground (job *j, int cont)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Put the job into the foreground. */
|
||
tcsetpgrp (shell_terminal, j->pgid);
|
||
|
||
/* Send the job a continue signal, if necessary. */
|
||
if (cont)
|
||
{
|
||
tcsetattr (shell_terminal, TCSADRAIN, &j->tmodes);
|
||
if (kill (- j->pgid, SIGCONT) < 0)
|
||
perror ("kill (SIGCONT)");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Wait for it to report. */
|
||
wait_for_job (j);
|
||
|
||
/* Put the shell back in the foreground. */
|
||
tcsetpgrp (shell_terminal, shell_pgid);
|
||
|
||
/* Restore the shell’s terminal modes. */
|
||
tcgetattr (shell_terminal, &j->tmodes);
|
||
tcsetattr (shell_terminal, TCSADRAIN, &shell_tmodes);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
If the process group is launched as a background job, the shell
|
||
should remain in the foreground itself and continue to read commands
|
||
from the terminal.
|
||
|
||
In the sample shell, there is not much that needs to be done to put a
|
||
job into the background. Here is the function it uses:
|
||
|
||
/* Put a job in the background. If the cont argument is true, send
|
||
the process group a ‘SIGCONT’ signal to wake it up. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
put_job_in_background (job *j, int cont)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Send the job a continue signal, if necessary. */
|
||
if (cont)
|
||
if (kill (-j->pgid, SIGCONT) < 0)
|
||
perror ("kill (SIGCONT)");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Stopped and Terminated Jobs, Next: Continuing Stopped Jobs, Prev: Foreground and Background, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.5 Stopped and Terminated Jobs
|
||
----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
When a foreground process is launched, the shell must block until all of
|
||
the processes in that job have either terminated or stopped. It can do
|
||
this by calling the ‘waitpid’ function; see *note Process Completion::.
|
||
Use the ‘WUNTRACED’ option so that status is reported for processes that
|
||
stop as well as processes that terminate.
|
||
|
||
The shell must also check on the status of background jobs so that it
|
||
can report terminated and stopped jobs to the user; this can be done by
|
||
calling ‘waitpid’ with the ‘WNOHANG’ option. A good place to put a such
|
||
a check for terminated and stopped jobs is just before prompting for a
|
||
new command.
|
||
|
||
The shell can also receive asynchronous notification that there is
|
||
status information available for a child process by establishing a
|
||
handler for ‘SIGCHLD’ signals. *Note Signal Handling::.
|
||
|
||
In the sample shell program, the ‘SIGCHLD’ signal is normally
|
||
ignored. This is to avoid reentrancy problems involving the global data
|
||
structures the shell manipulates. But at specific times when the shell
|
||
is not using these data structures—such as when it is waiting for input
|
||
on the terminal—it makes sense to enable a handler for ‘SIGCHLD’. The
|
||
same function that is used to do the synchronous status checks
|
||
(‘do_job_notification’, in this case) can also be called from within
|
||
this handler.
|
||
|
||
Here are the parts of the sample shell program that deal with
|
||
checking the status of jobs and reporting the information to the user.
|
||
|
||
/* Store the status of the process PID that was returned by waitpid.
|
||
Return 0 if all went well, nonzero otherwise. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
mark_process_status (pid_t pid, int status)
|
||
{
|
||
job *j;
|
||
process *p;
|
||
|
||
if (pid > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Update the record for the process. */
|
||
for (j = first_job; j; j = j->next)
|
||
for (p = j->first_process; p; p = p->next)
|
||
if (p->pid == pid)
|
||
{
|
||
p->status = status;
|
||
if (WIFSTOPPED (status))
|
||
p->stopped = 1;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
p->completed = 1;
|
||
if (WIFSIGNALED (status))
|
||
fprintf (stderr, "%d: Terminated by signal %d.\n",
|
||
(int) pid, WTERMSIG (p->status));
|
||
}
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
fprintf (stderr, "No child process %d.\n", pid);
|
||
return -1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (pid == 0 || errno == ECHILD)
|
||
/* No processes ready to report. */
|
||
return -1;
|
||
else {
|
||
/* Other weird errors. */
|
||
perror ("waitpid");
|
||
return -1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check for processes that have status information available,
|
||
without blocking. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
update_status (void)
|
||
{
|
||
int status;
|
||
pid_t pid;
|
||
|
||
do
|
||
pid = waitpid (WAIT_ANY, &status, WUNTRACED|WNOHANG);
|
||
while (!mark_process_status (pid, status));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check for processes that have status information available,
|
||
blocking until all processes in the given job have reported. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
wait_for_job (job *j)
|
||
{
|
||
int status;
|
||
pid_t pid;
|
||
|
||
do
|
||
pid = waitpid (WAIT_ANY, &status, WUNTRACED);
|
||
while (!mark_process_status (pid, status)
|
||
&& !job_is_stopped (j)
|
||
&& !job_is_completed (j));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Format information about job status for the user to look at. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
format_job_info (job *j, const char *status)
|
||
{
|
||
fprintf (stderr, "%ld (%s): %s\n", (long)j->pgid, status, j->command);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Notify the user about stopped or terminated jobs.
|
||
Delete terminated jobs from the active job list. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
do_job_notification (void)
|
||
{
|
||
job *j, *jlast, *jnext;
|
||
|
||
/* Update status information for child processes. */
|
||
update_status ();
|
||
|
||
jlast = NULL;
|
||
for (j = first_job; j; j = jnext)
|
||
{
|
||
jnext = j->next;
|
||
|
||
/* If all processes have completed, tell the user the job has
|
||
completed and delete it from the list of active jobs. */
|
||
if (job_is_completed (j)) {
|
||
format_job_info (j, "completed");
|
||
if (jlast)
|
||
jlast->next = jnext;
|
||
else
|
||
first_job = jnext;
|
||
free_job (j);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Notify the user about stopped jobs,
|
||
marking them so that we won’t do this more than once. */
|
||
else if (job_is_stopped (j) && !j->notified) {
|
||
format_job_info (j, "stopped");
|
||
j->notified = 1;
|
||
jlast = j;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Don’t say anything about jobs that are still running. */
|
||
else
|
||
jlast = j;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Continuing Stopped Jobs, Next: Missing Pieces, Prev: Stopped and Terminated Jobs, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.6 Continuing Stopped Jobs
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The shell can continue a stopped job by sending a ‘SIGCONT’ signal to
|
||
its process group. If the job is being continued in the foreground, the
|
||
shell should first invoke ‘tcsetpgrp’ to give the job access to the
|
||
terminal, and restore the saved terminal settings. After continuing a
|
||
job in the foreground, the shell should wait for the job to stop or
|
||
complete, as if the job had just been launched in the foreground.
|
||
|
||
The sample shell program handles both newly created and continued
|
||
jobs with the same pair of functions, ‘put_job_in_foreground’ and
|
||
‘put_job_in_background’. The definitions of these functions were given
|
||
in *note Foreground and Background::. When continuing a stopped job, a
|
||
nonzero value is passed as the CONT argument to ensure that the
|
||
‘SIGCONT’ signal is sent and the terminal modes reset, as appropriate.
|
||
|
||
This leaves only a function for updating the shell’s internal
|
||
bookkeeping about the job being continued:
|
||
|
||
/* Mark a stopped job J as being running again. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
mark_job_as_running (job *j)
|
||
{
|
||
Process *p;
|
||
|
||
for (p = j->first_process; p; p = p->next)
|
||
p->stopped = 0;
|
||
j->notified = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Continue the job J. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
continue_job (job *j, int foreground)
|
||
{
|
||
mark_job_as_running (j);
|
||
if (foreground)
|
||
put_job_in_foreground (j, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
put_job_in_background (j, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Missing Pieces, Prev: Continuing Stopped Jobs, Up: Implementing a Shell
|
||
|
||
28.5.7 The Missing Pieces
|
||
-------------------------
|
||
|
||
The code extracts for the sample shell included in this chapter are only
|
||
a part of the entire shell program. In particular, nothing at all has
|
||
been said about how ‘job’ and ‘program’ data structures are allocated
|
||
and initialized.
|
||
|
||
Most real shells provide a complex user interface that has support
|
||
for a command language; variables; abbreviations, substitutions, and
|
||
pattern matching on file names; and the like. All of this is far too
|
||
complicated to explain here! Instead, we have concentrated on showing
|
||
how to implement the core process creation and job control functions
|
||
that can be called from such a shell.
|
||
|
||
Here is a table summarizing the major entry points we have presented:
|
||
|
||
‘void init_shell (void)’
|
||
Initialize the shell’s internal state. *Note Initializing the
|
||
Shell::.
|
||
|
||
‘void launch_job (job *J, int FOREGROUND)’
|
||
Launch the job J as either a foreground or background job. *Note
|
||
Launching Jobs::.
|
||
|
||
‘void do_job_notification (void)’
|
||
Check for and report any jobs that have terminated or stopped. Can
|
||
be called synchronously or within a handler for ‘SIGCHLD’ signals.
|
||
*Note Stopped and Terminated Jobs::.
|
||
|
||
‘void continue_job (job *J, int FOREGROUND)’
|
||
Continue the job J. *Note Continuing Stopped Jobs::.
|
||
|
||
Of course, a real shell would also want to provide other functions
|
||
for managing jobs. For example, it would be useful to have commands to
|
||
list all active jobs or to send a signal (such as ‘SIGKILL’) to a job.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Functions for Job Control, Prev: Implementing a Shell, Up: Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.6 Functions for Job Control
|
||
==============================
|
||
|
||
This section contains detailed descriptions of the functions relating to
|
||
job control.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Identifying the Terminal:: Determining the controlling terminal’s name.
|
||
* Process Group Functions:: Functions for manipulating process groups.
|
||
* Terminal Access Functions:: Functions for controlling terminal access.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Identifying the Terminal, Next: Process Group Functions, Up: Functions for Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.6.1 Identifying the Controlling Terminal
|
||
-------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can use the ‘ctermid’ function to get a file name that you can use
|
||
to open the controlling terminal. In the GNU C Library, it returns the
|
||
same string all the time: ‘"/dev/tty"’. That is a special “magic” file
|
||
name that refers to the controlling terminal of the current process (if
|
||
it has one). To find the name of the specific terminal device, use
|
||
‘ttyname’; *note Is It a Terminal::.
|
||
|
||
The function ‘ctermid’ is declared in the header file ‘stdio.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: char * ctermid (char *STRING)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe !posix/!string | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘ctermid’ function returns a string containing the file name of
|
||
the controlling terminal for the current process. If STRING is not
|
||
a null pointer, it should be an array that can hold at least
|
||
‘L_ctermid’ characters; the string is returned in this array.
|
||
Otherwise, a pointer to a string in a static area is returned,
|
||
which might get overwritten on subsequent calls to this function.
|
||
|
||
An empty string is returned if the file name cannot be determined
|
||
for any reason. Even if a file name is returned, access to the
|
||
file it represents is not guaranteed.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int L_ctermid
|
||
|
||
The value of this macro is an integer constant expression that
|
||
represents the size of a string large enough to hold the file name
|
||
returned by ‘ctermid’.
|
||
|
||
See also the ‘isatty’ and ‘ttyname’ functions, in *note Is It a
|
||
Terminal::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Process Group Functions, Next: Terminal Access Functions, Prev: Identifying the Terminal, Up: Functions for Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.6.2 Process Group Functions
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Here are descriptions of the functions for manipulating process groups.
|
||
Your program should include the header files ‘sys/types.h’ and
|
||
‘unistd.h’ to use these functions.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: pid_t setsid (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘setsid’ function creates a new session. The calling process
|
||
becomes the session leader, and is put in a new process group whose
|
||
process group ID is the same as the process ID of that process.
|
||
There are initially no other processes in the new process group,
|
||
and no other process groups in the new session.
|
||
|
||
This function also makes the calling process have no controlling
|
||
terminal.
|
||
|
||
The ‘setsid’ function returns the new process group ID of the
|
||
calling process if successful. A return value of ‘-1’ indicates an
|
||
error. The following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this
|
||
function:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The calling process is already a process group leader, or
|
||
there is already another process group around that has the
|
||
same process group ID.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: pid_t getsid (pid_t PID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getsid’ function returns the process group ID of the session
|
||
leader of the specified process. If a PID is ‘0’, the process
|
||
group ID of the session leader of the current process is returned.
|
||
|
||
In case of error ‘-1’ is returned and ‘errno’ is set. The
|
||
following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘ESRCH’
|
||
There is no process with the given process ID PID.
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The calling process and the process specified by PID are in
|
||
different sessions, and the implementation doesn’t allow to
|
||
access the process group ID of the session leader of the
|
||
process with ID PID from the calling process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: pid_t getpgrp (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getpgrp’ function returns the process group ID of the calling
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getpgid (pid_t PID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getpgid’ function returns the process group ID of the process
|
||
PID. You can supply a value of ‘0’ for the PID argument to get
|
||
information about the calling process.
|
||
|
||
In case of error ‘-1’ is returned and ‘errno’ is set. The
|
||
following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘ESRCH’
|
||
There is no process with the given process ID PID. The
|
||
calling process and the process specified by PID are in
|
||
different sessions, and the implementation doesn’t allow to
|
||
access the process group ID of the process with ID PID from
|
||
the calling process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setpgid (pid_t PID, pid_t PGID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘setpgid’ function puts the process PID into the process group
|
||
PGID. As a special case, either PID or PGID can be zero to
|
||
indicate the process ID of the calling process.
|
||
|
||
If the operation is successful, ‘setpgid’ returns zero. Otherwise
|
||
it returns ‘-1’. The following ‘errno’ error conditions are
|
||
defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EACCES’
|
||
The child process named by PID has executed an ‘exec’ function
|
||
since it was forked.
|
||
|
||
‘EINVAL’
|
||
The value of the PGID is not valid.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOSYS’
|
||
The system doesn’t support job control.
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The process indicated by the PID argument is a session leader,
|
||
or is not in the same session as the calling process, or the
|
||
value of the PGID argument doesn’t match a process group ID in
|
||
the same session as the calling process.
|
||
|
||
‘ESRCH’
|
||
The process indicated by the PID argument is not the calling
|
||
process or a child of the calling process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setpgrp (pid_t PID, pid_t PGID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This is the BSD Unix name for ‘setpgid’. Both functions do exactly
|
||
the same thing.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Terminal Access Functions, Prev: Process Group Functions, Up: Functions for Job Control
|
||
|
||
28.6.3 Functions for Controlling Terminal Access
|
||
------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
These are the functions for reading or setting the foreground process
|
||
group of a terminal. You should include the header files ‘sys/types.h’
|
||
and ‘unistd.h’ in your application to use these functions.
|
||
|
||
Although these functions take a file descriptor argument to specify
|
||
the terminal device, the foreground job is associated with the terminal
|
||
file itself and not a particular open file descriptor.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: pid_t tcgetpgrp (int FILEDES)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the process group ID of the foreground
|
||
process group associated with the terminal open on descriptor
|
||
FILEDES.
|
||
|
||
If there is no foreground process group, the return value is a
|
||
number greater than ‘1’ that does not match the process group ID of
|
||
any existing process group. This can happen if all of the
|
||
processes in the job that was formerly the foreground job have
|
||
terminated, and no other job has yet been moved into the
|
||
foreground.
|
||
|
||
In case of an error, a value of ‘-1’ is returned. The following
|
||
‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EBADF’
|
||
The FILEDES argument is not a valid file descriptor.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOSYS’
|
||
The system doesn’t support job control.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOTTY’
|
||
The terminal file associated with the FILEDES argument isn’t
|
||
the controlling terminal of the calling process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int tcsetpgrp (int FILEDES, pid_t PGID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is used to set a terminal’s foreground process group
|
||
ID. The argument FILEDES is a descriptor which specifies the
|
||
terminal; PGID specifies the process group. The calling process
|
||
must be a member of the same session as PGID and must have the same
|
||
controlling terminal.
|
||
|
||
For terminal access purposes, this function is treated as output.
|
||
If it is called from a background process on its controlling
|
||
terminal, normally all processes in the process group are sent a
|
||
‘SIGTTOU’ signal. The exception is if the calling process itself
|
||
is ignoring or blocking ‘SIGTTOU’ signals, in which case the
|
||
operation is performed and no signal is sent.
|
||
|
||
If successful, ‘tcsetpgrp’ returns ‘0’. A return value of ‘-1’
|
||
indicates an error. The following ‘errno’ error conditions are
|
||
defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EBADF’
|
||
The FILEDES argument is not a valid file descriptor.
|
||
|
||
‘EINVAL’
|
||
The PGID argument is not valid.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOSYS’
|
||
The system doesn’t support job control.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOTTY’
|
||
The FILEDES isn’t the controlling terminal of the calling
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The PGID isn’t a process group in the same session as the
|
||
calling process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: pid_t tcgetsid (int FILDES)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is used to obtain the process group ID of the session
|
||
for which the terminal specified by FILDES is the controlling
|
||
terminal. If the call is successful the group ID is returned.
|
||
Otherwise the return value is ‘(pid_t) -1’ and the global variable
|
||
‘errno’ is set to the following value:
|
||
‘EBADF’
|
||
The FILEDES argument is not a valid file descriptor.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOTTY’
|
||
The calling process does not have a controlling terminal, or
|
||
the file is not the controlling terminal.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Name Service Switch, Next: Users and Groups, Prev: Job Control, Up: Top
|
||
|
||
29 System Databases and Name Service Switch
|
||
*******************************************
|
||
|
||
Various functions in the C Library need to be configured to work
|
||
correctly in the local environment. Traditionally, this was done by
|
||
using files (e.g., ‘/etc/passwd’), but other nameservices (like the
|
||
Network Information Service (NIS) and the Domain Name Service (DNS))
|
||
became popular, and were hacked into the C library, usually with a fixed
|
||
search order.
|
||
|
||
The GNU C Library contains a cleaner solution to this problem. It is
|
||
designed after a method used by Sun Microsystems in the C library of
|
||
Solaris 2. The GNU C Library follows their name and calls this scheme
|
||
"Name Service Switch" (NSS).
|
||
|
||
Though the interface might be similar to Sun’s version there is no
|
||
common code. We never saw any source code of Sun’s implementation and
|
||
so the internal interface is incompatible. This also manifests in the
|
||
file names we use as we will see later.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* NSS Basics:: What is this NSS good for.
|
||
* NSS Configuration File:: Configuring NSS.
|
||
* NSS Module Internals:: How does it work internally.
|
||
* Extending NSS:: What to do to add services or databases.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: NSS Basics, Next: NSS Configuration File, Prev: Name Service Switch, Up: Name Service Switch
|
||
|
||
29.1 NSS Basics
|
||
===============
|
||
|
||
The basic idea is to put the implementation of the different services
|
||
offered to access the databases in separate modules. This has some
|
||
advantages:
|
||
|
||
1. Contributors can add new services without adding them to the GNU C
|
||
Library.
|
||
2. The modules can be updated separately.
|
||
3. The C library image is smaller.
|
||
|
||
To fulfill the first goal above, the ABI of the modules will be
|
||
described below. For getting the implementation of a new service right
|
||
it is important to understand how the functions in the modules get
|
||
called. They are in no way designed to be used by the programmer
|
||
directly. Instead the programmer should only use the documented and
|
||
standardized functions to access the databases.
|
||
|
||
The databases available in the NSS are
|
||
|
||
‘aliases’
|
||
Mail aliases
|
||
‘ethers’
|
||
Ethernet numbers,
|
||
‘group’
|
||
Groups of users, *note Group Database::.
|
||
‘gshadow’
|
||
Group passphrase hashes and related information.
|
||
‘hosts’
|
||
Host names and numbers, *note Host Names::.
|
||
‘initgroups’
|
||
Supplementary group access list.
|
||
‘netgroup’
|
||
Network wide list of host and users, *note Netgroup Database::.
|
||
‘networks’
|
||
Network names and numbers, *note Networks Database::.
|
||
‘passwd’
|
||
User identities, *note User Database::.
|
||
‘protocols’
|
||
Network protocols, *note Protocols Database::.
|
||
‘publickey’
|
||
Public keys for Secure RPC.
|
||
‘rpc’
|
||
Remote procedure call names and numbers.
|
||
‘services’
|
||
Network services, *note Services Database::.
|
||
‘shadow’
|
||
User passphrase hashes and related information.
|
||
|
||
More databases may be added later.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: NSS Configuration File, Next: NSS Module Internals, Prev: NSS Basics, Up: Name Service Switch
|
||
|
||
29.2 The NSS Configuration File
|
||
===============================
|
||
|
||
Somehow the NSS code must be told about the wishes of the user. For
|
||
this reason there is the file ‘/etc/nsswitch.conf’. For each database,
|
||
this file contains a specification of how the lookup process should
|
||
work. The file could look like this:
|
||
|
||
# /etc/nsswitch.conf
|
||
#
|
||
# Name Service Switch configuration file.
|
||
#
|
||
|
||
passwd: db files
|
||
shadow: files
|
||
group: db files
|
||
|
||
hosts: files dns
|
||
networks: files
|
||
|
||
ethers: db files
|
||
protocols: db files
|
||
rpc: db files
|
||
services: db files
|
||
|
||
The first column is the database as you can guess from the table
|
||
above. The rest of the line specifies how the lookup process works.
|
||
Please note that you specify the way it works for each database
|
||
individually. This cannot be done with the old way of a monolithic
|
||
implementation.
|
||
|
||
The configuration specification for each database can contain two
|
||
different items:
|
||
|
||
• the service specification like ‘files’, ‘db’, or ‘nis’.
|
||
• the reaction on lookup result like ‘[NOTFOUND=return]’.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Services in the NSS configuration:: Service names in the NSS configuration.
|
||
* Actions in the NSS configuration:: React appropriately to the lookup result.
|
||
* Notes on NSS Configuration File:: Things to take care about while
|
||
configuring NSS.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Services in the NSS configuration, Next: Actions in the NSS configuration, Prev: NSS Configuration File, Up: NSS Configuration File
|
||
|
||
29.2.1 Services in the NSS configuration File
|
||
---------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The above example file mentions five different services: ‘files’, ‘db’,
|
||
‘dns’, ‘nis’, and ‘nisplus’. This does not mean these services are
|
||
available on all sites and neither does it mean these are all the
|
||
services which will ever be available.
|
||
|
||
In fact, these names are simply strings which the NSS code uses to
|
||
find the implicitly addressed functions. The internal interface will be
|
||
described later. Visible to the user are the modules which implement an
|
||
individual service.
|
||
|
||
Assume the service NAME shall be used for a lookup. The code for
|
||
this service is implemented in a module called ‘libnss_NAME’. On a
|
||
system supporting shared libraries this is in fact a shared library with
|
||
the name (for example) ‘libnss_NAME.so.2’. The number at the end is the
|
||
currently used version of the interface which will not change
|
||
frequently. Normally the user should not have to be cognizant of these
|
||
files since they should be placed in a directory where they are found
|
||
automatically. Only the names of all available services are important.
|
||
|
||
Lastly, some system software may make use of the NSS configuration
|
||
file to store their own configuration for similar purposes. Examples of
|
||
this include the ‘automount’ service which is used by ‘autofs’.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Actions in the NSS configuration, Next: Notes on NSS Configuration File, Prev: Services in the NSS configuration, Up: NSS Configuration File
|
||
|
||
29.2.2 Actions in the NSS configuration
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The second item in the specification gives the user much finer control
|
||
on the lookup process. Action items are placed between two service
|
||
names and are written within brackets. The general form is
|
||
|
||
‘[’ ( ‘!’? STATUS ‘=’ ACTION )+ ‘]’
|
||
|
||
where
|
||
|
||
STATUS ⇒ success | notfound | unavail | tryagain
|
||
ACTION ⇒ return | continue
|
||
|
||
The case of the keywords is insignificant. The STATUS values are the
|
||
results of a call to a lookup function of a specific service. They
|
||
mean:
|
||
|
||
‘success’
|
||
No error occurred and the wanted entry is returned. The default
|
||
action for this is ‘return’.
|
||
|
||
‘notfound’
|
||
The lookup process works ok but the needed value was not found.
|
||
The default action is ‘continue’.
|
||
|
||
‘unavail’
|
||
The service is permanently unavailable. This can either mean the
|
||
needed file is not available, or, for DNS, the server is not
|
||
available or does not allow queries. The default action is
|
||
‘continue’.
|
||
|
||
‘tryagain’
|
||
The service is temporarily unavailable. This could mean a file is
|
||
locked or a server currently cannot accept more connections. The
|
||
default action is ‘continue’.
|
||
|
||
The ACTION values mean:
|
||
|
||
‘return’
|
||
|
||
If the status matches, stop the lookup process at this service
|
||
specification. If an entry is available, provide it to the
|
||
application. If an error occurred, report it to the application.
|
||
In case of a prior ‘merge’ action, the data is combined with
|
||
previous lookup results, as explained below.
|
||
|
||
‘continue’
|
||
|
||
If the status matches, proceed with the lookup process at the next
|
||
entry, discarding the result of the current lookup (and any merged
|
||
data). An exception is the ‘initgroups’ database and the ‘success’
|
||
status, where ‘continue’ acts like ‘merge’ below.
|
||
|
||
‘merge’
|
||
|
||
Proceed with the lookup process, retaining the current lookup
|
||
result. This action is useful only with the ‘success’ status. If
|
||
a subsequent service lookup succeeds and has a matching ‘return’
|
||
specification, the results are merged, the lookup process ends, and
|
||
the merged results are returned to the application. If the
|
||
following service has a matching ‘merge’ action, the lookup process
|
||
continues, retaining the combined data from this and any previous
|
||
lookups.
|
||
|
||
After a ‘merge’ action, errors from subsequent lookups are ignored,
|
||
and the data gathered so far will be returned.
|
||
|
||
The ‘merge’ only applies to the ‘success’ status. It is currently
|
||
implemented for the ‘group’ database and its group members field,
|
||
‘gr_mem’. If specified for other databases, it causes the lookup
|
||
to fail (if the STATUS matches).
|
||
|
||
When processing ‘merge’ for ‘group’ membership, the group GID and
|
||
name must be identical for both entries. If only one or the other
|
||
is a match, the behavior is undefined.
|
||
|
||
If we have a line like
|
||
|
||
ethers: nisplus [NOTFOUND=return] db files
|
||
|
||
this is equivalent to
|
||
|
||
ethers: nisplus [SUCCESS=return NOTFOUND=return UNAVAIL=continue
|
||
TRYAGAIN=continue]
|
||
db [SUCCESS=return NOTFOUND=continue UNAVAIL=continue
|
||
TRYAGAIN=continue]
|
||
files
|
||
|
||
(except that it would have to be written on one line). The default
|
||
value for the actions are normally what you want, and only need to be
|
||
changed in exceptional cases.
|
||
|
||
If the optional ‘!’ is placed before the STATUS this means the
|
||
following action is used for all statuses but STATUS itself. I.e., ‘!’
|
||
is negation as in the C language (and others).
|
||
|
||
Before we explain the exception which makes this action item
|
||
necessary one more remark: obviously it makes no sense to add another
|
||
action item after the ‘files’ service. Since there is no other service
|
||
following the action _always_ is ‘return’.
|
||
|
||
Now, why is this ‘[NOTFOUND=return]’ action useful? To understand
|
||
this we should know that the ‘nisplus’ service is often complete; i.e.,
|
||
if an entry is not available in the NIS+ tables it is not available
|
||
anywhere else. This is what is expressed by this action item: it is
|
||
useless to examine further services since they will not give us a
|
||
result.
|
||
|
||
The situation would be different if the NIS+ service is not available
|
||
because the machine is booting. In this case the return value of the
|
||
lookup function is not ‘notfound’ but instead ‘unavail’. And as you can
|
||
see in the complete form above: in this situation the ‘db’ and ‘files’
|
||
services are used. Neat, isn’t it? The system administrator need not
|
||
pay special care for the time the system is not completely ready to work
|
||
(while booting or shutdown or network problems).
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Notes on NSS Configuration File, Prev: Actions in the NSS configuration, Up: NSS Configuration File
|
||
|
||
29.2.3 Notes on the NSS Configuration File
|
||
------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Finally a few more hints. The NSS implementation is not completely
|
||
helpless if ‘/etc/nsswitch.conf’ does not exist. For all supported
|
||
databases there is a default value so it should normally be possible to
|
||
get the system running even if the file is corrupted or missing.
|
||
|
||
For the ‘hosts’ and ‘networks’ databases the default value is ‘dns
|
||
[!UNAVAIL=return] files’. I.e., the system is prepared for the DNS
|
||
service not to be available but if it is available the answer it returns
|
||
is definitive.
|
||
|
||
The ‘passwd’, ‘group’, and ‘shadow’ databases was traditionally
|
||
handled in a special way. The appropriate files in the ‘/etc’ directory
|
||
were read but if an entry with a name starting with a ‘+’ character was
|
||
found NIS was used. This kind of lookup was removed and now the default
|
||
value for the services is ‘files’. libnss_compat no longer depends on
|
||
libnsl and can be used without NIS.
|
||
|
||
For all other databases the default value is ‘files’.
|
||
|
||
A second point is that the user should try to optimize the lookup
|
||
process. The different service have different response times. A simple
|
||
file look up on a local file could be fast, but if the file is long and
|
||
the needed entry is near the end of the file this may take quite some
|
||
time. In this case it might be better to use the ‘db’ service which
|
||
allows fast local access to large data sets.
|
||
|
||
Often the situation is that some global information like NIS must be
|
||
used. So it is unavoidable to use service entries like ‘nis’ etc. But
|
||
one should avoid slow services like this if possible.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: NSS Module Internals, Next: Extending NSS, Prev: NSS Configuration File, Up: Name Service Switch
|
||
|
||
29.3 NSS Module Internals
|
||
=========================
|
||
|
||
Now it is time to describe what the modules look like. The functions
|
||
contained in a module are identified by their names. I.e., there is no
|
||
jump table or the like. How this is done is of no interest here; those
|
||
interested in this topic should read about Dynamic Linking.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* NSS Module Names:: Construction of the interface function of
|
||
the NSS modules.
|
||
* NSS Modules Interface:: Programming interface in the NSS module
|
||
functions.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: NSS Module Names, Next: NSS Modules Interface, Prev: NSS Module Internals, Up: NSS Module Internals
|
||
|
||
29.3.1 The Naming Scheme of the NSS Modules
|
||
-------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The name of each function consists of various parts:
|
||
|
||
_nss_SERVICE_FUNCTION
|
||
|
||
SERVICE of course corresponds to the name of the module this function
|
||
is found in.(1) The FUNCTION part is derived from the interface
|
||
function in the C library itself. If the user calls the function
|
||
‘gethostbyname’ and the service used is ‘files’ the function
|
||
|
||
_nss_files_gethostbyname_r
|
||
|
||
in the module
|
||
|
||
libnss_files.so.2
|
||
|
||
is used. You see, what is explained above in not the whole truth. In
|
||
fact the NSS modules only contain reentrant versions of the lookup
|
||
functions. I.e., if the user would call the ‘gethostbyname_r’ function
|
||
this also would end in the above function. For all user interface
|
||
functions the C library maps this call to a call to the reentrant
|
||
function. For reentrant functions this is trivial since the interface
|
||
is (nearly) the same. For the non-reentrant version the library keeps
|
||
internal buffers which are used to replace the user supplied buffer.
|
||
|
||
I.e., the reentrant functions _can_ have counterparts. No service
|
||
module is forced to have functions for all databases and all kinds to
|
||
access them. If a function is not available it is simply treated as if
|
||
the function would return ‘unavail’ (*note Actions in the NSS
|
||
configuration::).
|
||
|
||
The file name ‘libnss_files.so.2’ would be on a Solaris 2 system
|
||
‘nss_files.so.2’. This is the difference mentioned above. Sun’s NSS
|
||
modules are usable as modules which get indirectly loaded only.
|
||
|
||
The NSS modules in the GNU C Library are prepared to be used as
|
||
normal libraries themselves. This is _not_ true at the moment, though.
|
||
However, the organization of the name space in the modules does not make
|
||
it impossible like it is for Solaris. Now you can see why the modules
|
||
are still libraries.(2)
|
||
|
||
---------- Footnotes ----------
|
||
|
||
(1) Now you might ask why this information is duplicated. The answer
|
||
is that we want to make it possible to link directly with these shared
|
||
objects.
|
||
|
||
(2) There is a second explanation: we were too lazy to change the
|
||
Makefiles to allow the generation of shared objects not starting with
|
||
‘lib’ but don’t tell this to anybody.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: NSS Modules Interface, Prev: NSS Module Names, Up: NSS Module Internals
|
||
|
||
29.3.2 The Interface of the Function in NSS Modules
|
||
---------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Now we know about the functions contained in the modules. It is now
|
||
time to describe the types. When we mentioned the reentrant versions of
|
||
the functions above, this means there are some additional arguments
|
||
(compared with the standard, non-reentrant versions). The prototypes
|
||
for the non-reentrant and reentrant versions of our function above are:
|
||
|
||
struct hostent *gethostbyname (const char *name)
|
||
|
||
int gethostbyname_r (const char *name, struct hostent *result_buf,
|
||
char *buf, size_t buflen, struct hostent **result,
|
||
int *h_errnop)
|
||
|
||
The actual prototype of the function in the NSS modules in this case is
|
||
|
||
enum nss_status _nss_files_gethostbyname_r (const char *name,
|
||
struct hostent *result_buf,
|
||
char *buf, size_t buflen,
|
||
int *errnop, int *h_errnop)
|
||
|
||
I.e., the interface function is in fact the reentrant function with
|
||
the change of the return value, the omission of the RESULT parameter,
|
||
and the addition of the ERRNOP parameter. While the user-level function
|
||
returns a pointer to the result the reentrant function return an ‘enum
|
||
nss_status’ value:
|
||
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_TRYAGAIN’
|
||
numeric value ‘-2’
|
||
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_UNAVAIL’
|
||
numeric value ‘-1’
|
||
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_NOTFOUND’
|
||
numeric value ‘0’
|
||
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_SUCCESS’
|
||
numeric value ‘1’
|
||
|
||
Now you see where the action items of the ‘/etc/nsswitch.conf’ file are
|
||
used.
|
||
|
||
If you study the source code you will find there is a fifth value:
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_RETURN’. This is an internal use only value, used by a few
|
||
functions in places where none of the above value can be used. If
|
||
necessary the source code should be examined to learn about the details.
|
||
|
||
In case the interface function has to return an error it is important
|
||
that the correct error code is stored in ‘*ERRNOP’. Some return status
|
||
values have only one associated error code, others have more.
|
||
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_TRYAGAIN’ ‘EAGAIN’ One of the functions used ran
|
||
temporarily out of resources or a
|
||
service is currently not
|
||
available.
|
||
‘ERANGE’ The provided buffer is not large
|
||
enough. The function should be
|
||
called again with a larger buffer.
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_UNAVAIL’ ‘ENOENT’ A necessary input file cannot be
|
||
found.
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_NOTFOUND’ ‘ENOENT’ The requested entry is not
|
||
available.
|
||
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_NOTFOUND’ ‘SUCCESS’ There are no entries. Use this to
|
||
avoid returning errors for
|
||
inactive services which may be
|
||
enabled at a later time. This is
|
||
not the same as the service being
|
||
temporarily unavailable.
|
||
|
||
These are proposed values. There can be other error codes and the
|
||
described error codes can have different meaning. *With one exception:*
|
||
when returning ‘NSS_STATUS_TRYAGAIN’ the error code ‘ERANGE’ _must_ mean
|
||
that the user provided buffer is too small. Everything else is
|
||
non-critical.
|
||
|
||
In statically linked programs, the main application and NSS modules
|
||
do not share the same thread-local variable ‘errno’, which is the reason
|
||
why there is an explicit ERRNOP function argument.
|
||
|
||
The above function has something special which is missing for almost
|
||
all the other module functions. There is an argument H_ERRNOP. This
|
||
points to a variable which will be filled with the error code in case
|
||
the execution of the function fails for some reason. (In statically
|
||
linked programs, the thread-local variable ‘h_errno’ is not shared with
|
||
the main application.)
|
||
|
||
The ‘getXXXbyYYY’ functions are the most important functions in the
|
||
NSS modules. But there are others which implement the other ways to
|
||
access system databases (say for the user database, there are
|
||
‘setpwent’, ‘getpwent’, and ‘endpwent’). These will be described in
|
||
more detail later. Here we give a general way to determine the
|
||
signature of the module function:
|
||
|
||
• the return value is ‘enum nss_status’;
|
||
• the name (*note NSS Module Names::);
|
||
• the first arguments are identical to the arguments of the
|
||
non-reentrant function;
|
||
• the next four arguments are:
|
||
|
||
‘STRUCT_TYPE *result_buf’
|
||
pointer to buffer where the result is stored. ‘STRUCT_TYPE’
|
||
is normally a struct which corresponds to the database.
|
||
‘char *buffer’
|
||
pointer to a buffer where the function can store additional
|
||
data for the result etc.
|
||
‘size_t buflen’
|
||
length of the buffer pointed to by BUFFER.
|
||
‘int *errnop’
|
||
the low-level error code to return to the application. If the
|
||
return value is not ‘NSS_STATUS_SUCCESS’, ‘*ERRNOP’ needs to
|
||
be set to a non-zero value. An NSS module should never set
|
||
‘*ERRNOP’ to zero. The value ‘ERANGE’ is special, as
|
||
described above.
|
||
|
||
• possibly a last argument H_ERRNOP, for the host name and network
|
||
name lookup functions. If the return value is not
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_SUCCESS’, ‘*H_ERRNOP’ needs to be set to a non-zero
|
||
value. A generic error code is ‘NETDB_INTERNAL’, which instructs
|
||
the caller to examine ‘*ERRNOP’ for further details. (This
|
||
includes the ‘ERANGE’ special case.)
|
||
|
||
This table is correct for all functions but the ‘set…ent’ and ‘end…ent’
|
||
functions.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Extending NSS, Prev: NSS Module Internals, Up: Name Service Switch
|
||
|
||
29.4 Extending NSS
|
||
==================
|
||
|
||
One of the advantages of NSS mentioned above is that it can be extended
|
||
quite easily. There are two ways in which the extension can happen:
|
||
adding another database or adding another service. The former is
|
||
normally done only by the C library developers. It is here only
|
||
important to remember that adding another database is independent from
|
||
adding another service because a service need not support all databases
|
||
or lookup functions.
|
||
|
||
A designer/implementer of a new service is therefore free to choose
|
||
the databases s/he is interested in and leave the rest for later (or
|
||
completely aside).
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Adding another Service to NSS:: What is to do to add a new service.
|
||
* NSS Module Function Internals:: Guidelines for writing new NSS
|
||
service functions.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Adding another Service to NSS, Next: NSS Module Function Internals, Prev: Extending NSS, Up: Extending NSS
|
||
|
||
29.4.1 Adding another Service to NSS
|
||
------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The sources for a new service need not (and should not) be part of the
|
||
GNU C Library itself. The developer retains complete control over the
|
||
sources and its development. The links between the C library and the
|
||
new service module consists solely of the interface functions.
|
||
|
||
Each module is designed following a specific interface specification.
|
||
For now the version is 2 (the interface in version 1 was not adequate)
|
||
and this manifests in the version number of the shared library object of
|
||
the NSS modules: they have the extension ‘.2’. If the interface changes
|
||
again in an incompatible way, this number will be increased. Modules
|
||
using the old interface will still be usable.
|
||
|
||
Developers of a new service will have to make sure that their module
|
||
is created using the correct interface number. This means the file
|
||
itself must have the correct name and on ELF systems the "soname"
|
||
(Shared Object Name) must also have this number. Building a module from
|
||
a bunch of object files on an ELF system using GNU CC could be done like
|
||
this:
|
||
|
||
gcc -shared -o libnss_NAME.so.2 -Wl,-soname,libnss_NAME.so.2 OBJECTS
|
||
|
||
*note Options for Linking: (gcc)Link Options, to learn more about this
|
||
command line.
|
||
|
||
To use the new module the library must be able to find it. This can
|
||
be achieved by using options for the dynamic linker so that it will
|
||
search the directory where the binary is placed. For an ELF system this
|
||
could be done by adding the wanted directory to the value of
|
||
‘LD_LIBRARY_PATH’.
|
||
|
||
But this is not always possible since some programs (those which run
|
||
under IDs which do not belong to the user) ignore this variable.
|
||
Therefore the stable version of the module should be placed into a
|
||
directory which is searched by the dynamic linker. Normally this should
|
||
be the directory ‘$prefix/lib’, where ‘$prefix’ corresponds to the value
|
||
given to configure using the ‘--prefix’ option. But be careful: this
|
||
should only be done if it is clear the module does not cause any harm.
|
||
System administrators should be careful.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: NSS Module Function Internals, Prev: Adding another Service to NSS, Up: Extending NSS
|
||
|
||
29.4.2 Internals of the NSS Module Functions
|
||
--------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Until now we only provided the syntactic interface for the functions in
|
||
the NSS module. In fact there is not much more we can say since the
|
||
implementation obviously is different for each function. But a few
|
||
general rules must be followed by all functions.
|
||
|
||
In fact there are four kinds of different functions which may appear
|
||
in the interface. All derive from the traditional ones for system
|
||
databases. DB in the following table is normally an abbreviation for
|
||
the database (e.g., it is ‘pw’ for the user database).
|
||
|
||
‘enum nss_status _nss_DATABASE_setDBent (void)’
|
||
This function prepares the service for following operations. For a
|
||
simple file based lookup this means files could be opened, for
|
||
other services this function simply is a noop.
|
||
|
||
One special case for this function is that it takes an additional
|
||
argument for some DATABASEs (i.e., the interface is ‘int setDBent
|
||
(int)’). *note Host Names::, which describes the ‘sethostent’
|
||
function.
|
||
|
||
The return value should be NSS_STATUS_SUCCESS or according to the
|
||
table above in case of an error (*note NSS Modules Interface::).
|
||
|
||
‘enum nss_status _nss_DATABASE_endDBent (void)’
|
||
This function simply closes all files which are still open or
|
||
removes buffer caches. If there are no files or buffers to remove
|
||
this is again a simple noop.
|
||
|
||
There normally is no return value other than NSS_STATUS_SUCCESS.
|
||
|
||
‘enum nss_status _nss_DATABASE_getDBent_r (STRUCTURE *result, char *buffer, size_t buflen, int *errnop)’
|
||
Since this function will be called several times in a row to
|
||
retrieve one entry after the other it must keep some kind of state.
|
||
But this also means the functions are not really reentrant. They
|
||
are reentrant only in that simultaneous calls to this function will
|
||
not try to write the retrieved data in the same place (as it would
|
||
be the case for the non-reentrant functions); instead, it writes to
|
||
the structure pointed to by the RESULT parameter. But the calls
|
||
share a common state and in the case of a file access this means
|
||
they return neighboring entries in the file.
|
||
|
||
The buffer of length BUFLEN pointed to by BUFFER can be used for
|
||
storing some additional data for the result. It is _not_
|
||
guaranteed that the same buffer will be passed for the next call of
|
||
this function. Therefore one must not misuse this buffer to save
|
||
some state information from one call to another.
|
||
|
||
Before the function returns with a failure code, the implementation
|
||
should store the value of the local ‘errno’ variable in the
|
||
variable pointed to be ERRNOP. This is important to guarantee the
|
||
module working in statically linked programs. The stored value
|
||
must not be zero.
|
||
|
||
As explained above this function could also have an additional last
|
||
argument. This depends on the database used; it happens only for
|
||
‘host’ and ‘networks’.
|
||
|
||
The function shall return ‘NSS_STATUS_SUCCESS’ as long as there are
|
||
more entries. When the last entry was read it should return
|
||
‘NSS_STATUS_NOTFOUND’. When the buffer given as an argument is too
|
||
small for the data to be returned ‘NSS_STATUS_TRYAGAIN’ should be
|
||
returned. When the service was not formerly initialized by a call
|
||
to ‘_nss_DATABASE_setDBent’ all return values allowed for this
|
||
function can also be returned here.
|
||
|
||
‘enum nss_status _nss_DATABASE_getDBbyXX_r (PARAMS, STRUCTURE *result, char *buffer, size_t buflen, int *errnop)’
|
||
This function shall return the entry from the database which is
|
||
addressed by the PARAMS. The type and number of these arguments
|
||
vary. It must be individually determined by looking to the
|
||
user-level interface functions. All arguments given to the
|
||
non-reentrant version are here described by PARAMS.
|
||
|
||
The result must be stored in the structure pointed to by RESULT.
|
||
If there are additional data to return (say strings, where the
|
||
RESULT structure only contains pointers) the function must use the
|
||
BUFFER of length BUFLEN. There must not be any references to
|
||
non-constant global data.
|
||
|
||
The implementation of this function should honor the STAYOPEN flag
|
||
set by the ‘setDBent’ function whenever this makes sense.
|
||
|
||
Before the function returns, the implementation should store the
|
||
value of the local ‘errno’ variable in the variable pointed to by
|
||
ERRNOP. This is important to guarantee the module works in
|
||
statically linked programs.
|
||
|
||
Again, this function takes an additional last argument for the
|
||
‘host’ and ‘networks’ database.
|
||
|
||
The return value should as always follow the rules given above
|
||
(*note NSS Modules Interface::).
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Users and Groups, Next: System Management, Prev: Name Service Switch, Up: Top
|
||
|
||
30 Users and Groups
|
||
*******************
|
||
|
||
Every user who can log in on the system is identified by a unique number
|
||
called the "user ID". Each process has an effective user ID which says
|
||
which user’s access permissions it has.
|
||
|
||
Users are classified into "groups" for access control purposes. Each
|
||
process has one or more "group ID values" which say which groups the
|
||
process can use for access to files.
|
||
|
||
The effective user and group IDs of a process collectively form its
|
||
"persona". This determines which files the process can access.
|
||
Normally, a process inherits its persona from the parent process, but
|
||
under special circumstances a process can change its persona and thus
|
||
change its access permissions.
|
||
|
||
Each file in the system also has a user ID and a group ID. Access
|
||
control works by comparing the user and group IDs of the file with those
|
||
of the running process.
|
||
|
||
The system keeps a database of all the registered users, and another
|
||
database of all the defined groups. There are library functions you can
|
||
use to examine these databases.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* User and Group IDs:: Each user has a unique numeric ID;
|
||
likewise for groups.
|
||
* Process Persona:: The user IDs and group IDs of a process.
|
||
* Why Change Persona:: Why a program might need to change
|
||
its user and/or group IDs.
|
||
* How Change Persona:: Changing the user and group IDs.
|
||
* Reading Persona:: How to examine the user and group IDs.
|
||
|
||
* Setting User ID:: Functions for setting the user ID.
|
||
* Setting Groups:: Functions for setting the group IDs.
|
||
|
||
* Enable/Disable Setuid:: Turning setuid access on and off.
|
||
* Setuid Program Example:: The pertinent parts of one sample program.
|
||
* Tips for Setuid:: How to avoid granting unlimited access.
|
||
|
||
* Who Logged In:: Getting the name of the user who logged in,
|
||
or of the real user ID of the current process.
|
||
|
||
* User Accounting Database:: Keeping information about users and various
|
||
actions in databases.
|
||
|
||
* User Database:: Functions and data structures for
|
||
accessing the user database.
|
||
* Group Database:: Functions and data structures for
|
||
accessing the group database.
|
||
* Database Example:: Example program showing the use of database
|
||
inquiry functions.
|
||
* Netgroup Database:: Functions for accessing the netgroup database.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: User and Group IDs, Next: Process Persona, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.1 User and Group IDs
|
||
=======================
|
||
|
||
Each user account on a computer system is identified by a "user name"
|
||
(or "login name") and "user ID". Normally, each user name has a unique
|
||
user ID, but it is possible for several login names to have the same
|
||
user ID. The user names and corresponding user IDs are stored in a data
|
||
base which you can access as described in *note User Database::.
|
||
|
||
Users are classified in "groups". Each user name belongs to one
|
||
"default group" and may also belong to any number of "supplementary
|
||
groups". Users who are members of the same group can share resources
|
||
(such as files) that are not accessible to users who are not a member of
|
||
that group. Each group has a "group name" and "group ID". *Note Group
|
||
Database::, for how to find information about a group ID or group name.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Process Persona, Next: Why Change Persona, Prev: User and Group IDs, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.2 The Persona of a Process
|
||
=============================
|
||
|
||
At any time, each process has an "effective user ID", a "effective group
|
||
ID", and a set of "supplementary group IDs". These IDs determine the
|
||
privileges of the process. They are collectively called the "persona"
|
||
of the process, because they determine “who it is” for purposes of
|
||
access control.
|
||
|
||
Your login shell starts out with a persona which consists of your
|
||
user ID, your default group ID, and your supplementary group IDs (if you
|
||
are in more than one group). In normal circumstances, all your other
|
||
processes inherit these values.
|
||
|
||
A process also has a "real user ID" which identifies the user who
|
||
created the process, and a "real group ID" which identifies that user’s
|
||
default group. These values do not play a role in access control, so we
|
||
do not consider them part of the persona. But they are also important.
|
||
|
||
Both the real and effective user ID can be changed during the
|
||
lifetime of a process. *Note Why Change Persona::.
|
||
|
||
For details on how a process’s effective user ID and group IDs affect
|
||
its permission to access files, see *note Access Permission::.
|
||
|
||
The effective user ID of a process also controls permissions for
|
||
sending signals using the ‘kill’ function. *Note Signaling Another
|
||
Process::.
|
||
|
||
Finally, there are many operations which can only be performed by a
|
||
process whose effective user ID is zero. A process with this user ID is
|
||
a "privileged process". Commonly the user name ‘root’ is associated
|
||
with user ID 0, but there may be other user names with this ID.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Why Change Persona, Next: How Change Persona, Prev: Process Persona, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.3 Why Change the Persona of a Process?
|
||
=========================================
|
||
|
||
The most obvious situation where it is necessary for a process to change
|
||
its user and/or group IDs is the ‘login’ program. When ‘login’ starts
|
||
running, its user ID is ‘root’. Its job is to start a shell whose user
|
||
and group IDs are those of the user who is logging in. (To accomplish
|
||
this fully, ‘login’ must set the real user and group IDs as well as its
|
||
persona. But this is a special case.)
|
||
|
||
The more common case of changing persona is when an ordinary user
|
||
program needs access to a resource that wouldn’t ordinarily be
|
||
accessible to the user actually running it.
|
||
|
||
For example, you may have a file that is controlled by your program
|
||
but that shouldn’t be read or modified directly by other users, either
|
||
because it implements some kind of locking protocol, or because you want
|
||
to preserve the integrity or privacy of the information it contains.
|
||
This kind of restricted access can be implemented by having the program
|
||
change its effective user or group ID to match that of the resource.
|
||
|
||
Thus, imagine a game program that saves scores in a file. The game
|
||
program itself needs to be able to update this file no matter who is
|
||
running it, but if users can write the file without going through the
|
||
game, they can give themselves any scores they like. Some people
|
||
consider this undesirable, or even reprehensible. It can be prevented
|
||
by creating a new user ID and login name (say, ‘games’) to own the
|
||
scores file, and make the file writable only by this user. Then, when
|
||
the game program wants to update this file, it can change its effective
|
||
user ID to be that for ‘games’. In effect, the program must adopt the
|
||
persona of ‘games’ so it can write to the scores file.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: How Change Persona, Next: Reading Persona, Prev: Why Change Persona, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.4 How an Application Can Change Persona
|
||
==========================================
|
||
|
||
The ability to change the persona of a process can be a source of
|
||
unintentional privacy violations, or even intentional abuse. Because of
|
||
the potential for problems, changing persona is restricted to special
|
||
circumstances.
|
||
|
||
You can’t arbitrarily set your user ID or group ID to anything you
|
||
want; only privileged processes can do that. Instead, the normal way
|
||
for a program to change its persona is that it has been set up in
|
||
advance to change to a particular user or group. This is the function
|
||
of the setuid and setgid bits of a file’s access mode. *Note Permission
|
||
Bits::.
|
||
|
||
When the setuid bit of an executable file is on, executing that file
|
||
gives the process a third user ID: the "file user ID". This ID is set to
|
||
the owner ID of the file. The system then changes the effective user ID
|
||
to the file user ID. The real user ID remains as it was. Likewise, if
|
||
the setgid bit is on, the process is given a "file group ID" equal to
|
||
the group ID of the file, and its effective group ID is changed to the
|
||
file group ID.
|
||
|
||
If a process has a file ID (user or group), then it can at any time
|
||
change its effective ID to its real ID and back to its file ID. Programs
|
||
use this feature to relinquish their special privileges except when they
|
||
actually need them. This makes it less likely that they can be tricked
|
||
into doing something inappropriate with their privileges.
|
||
|
||
*Portability Note:* Older systems do not have file IDs. To determine
|
||
if a system has this feature, you can test the compiler define
|
||
‘_POSIX_SAVED_IDS’. (In the POSIX standard, file IDs are known as saved
|
||
IDs.)
|
||
|
||
*Note File Attributes::, for a more general discussion of file modes
|
||
and accessibility.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Reading Persona, Next: Setting User ID, Prev: How Change Persona, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.5 Reading the Persona of a Process
|
||
=====================================
|
||
|
||
Here are detailed descriptions of the functions for reading the user and
|
||
group IDs of a process, both real and effective. To use these
|
||
facilities, you must include the header files ‘sys/types.h’ and
|
||
‘unistd.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: uid_t
|
||
|
||
This is an integer data type used to represent user IDs. In the
|
||
GNU C Library, this is an alias for ‘unsigned int’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: gid_t
|
||
|
||
This is an integer data type used to represent group IDs. In the
|
||
GNU C Library, this is an alias for ‘unsigned int’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: uid_t getuid (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getuid’ function returns the real user ID of the process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: gid_t getgid (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getgid’ function returns the real group ID of the process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: uid_t geteuid (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘geteuid’ function returns the effective user ID of the
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: gid_t getegid (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getegid’ function returns the effective group ID of the
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getgroups (int COUNT, gid_t *GROUPS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getgroups’ function is used to inquire about the supplementary
|
||
group IDs of the process. Up to COUNT of these group IDs are
|
||
stored in the array GROUPS; the return value from the function is
|
||
the number of group IDs actually stored. If COUNT is smaller than
|
||
the total number of supplementary group IDs, then ‘getgroups’
|
||
returns a value of ‘-1’ and ‘errno’ is set to ‘EINVAL’.
|
||
|
||
If COUNT is zero, then ‘getgroups’ just returns the total number of
|
||
supplementary group IDs. On systems that do not support
|
||
supplementary groups, this will always be zero.
|
||
|
||
Here’s how to use ‘getgroups’ to read all the supplementary group
|
||
IDs:
|
||
|
||
gid_t *
|
||
read_all_groups (void)
|
||
{
|
||
int ngroups = getgroups (0, NULL);
|
||
gid_t *groups
|
||
= (gid_t *) xmalloc (ngroups * sizeof (gid_t));
|
||
int val = getgroups (ngroups, groups);
|
||
if (val < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
free (groups);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
return groups;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Setting User ID, Next: Setting Groups, Prev: Reading Persona, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.6 Setting the User ID
|
||
========================
|
||
|
||
This section describes the functions for altering the user ID (real
|
||
and/or effective) of a process. To use these facilities, you must
|
||
include the header files ‘sys/types.h’ and ‘unistd.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int seteuid (uid_t NEWEUID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function sets the effective user ID of a process to NEWEUID,
|
||
provided that the process is allowed to change its effective user
|
||
ID. A privileged process (effective user ID zero) can change its
|
||
effective user ID to any legal value. An unprivileged process with
|
||
a file user ID can change its effective user ID to its real user ID
|
||
or to its file user ID. Otherwise, a process may not change its
|
||
effective user ID at all.
|
||
|
||
The ‘seteuid’ function returns a value of ‘0’ to indicate
|
||
successful completion, and a value of ‘-1’ to indicate an error.
|
||
The following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this
|
||
function:
|
||
|
||
‘EINVAL’
|
||
The value of the NEWEUID argument is invalid.
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The process may not change to the specified ID.
|
||
|
||
Older systems (those without the ‘_POSIX_SAVED_IDS’ feature) do not
|
||
have this function.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setuid (uid_t NEWUID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
If the calling process is privileged, this function sets both the
|
||
real and effective user IDs of the process to NEWUID. It also
|
||
deletes the file user ID of the process, if any. NEWUID may be any
|
||
legal value. (Once this has been done, there is no way to recover
|
||
the old effective user ID.)
|
||
|
||
If the process is not privileged, and the system supports the
|
||
‘_POSIX_SAVED_IDS’ feature, then this function behaves like
|
||
‘seteuid’.
|
||
|
||
The return values and error conditions are the same as for
|
||
‘seteuid’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setreuid (uid_t RUID, uid_t EUID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function sets the real user ID of the process to RUID and the
|
||
effective user ID to EUID. If RUID is ‘-1’, it means not to change
|
||
the real user ID; likewise if EUID is ‘-1’, it means not to change
|
||
the effective user ID.
|
||
|
||
The ‘setreuid’ function exists for compatibility with 4.3 BSD Unix,
|
||
which does not support file IDs. You can use this function to swap
|
||
the effective and real user IDs of the process. (Privileged
|
||
processes are not limited to this particular usage.) If file IDs
|
||
are supported, you should use that feature instead of this
|
||
function. *Note Enable/Disable Setuid::.
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘0’ on success and ‘-1’ on failure. The
|
||
following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The process does not have the appropriate privileges; you do
|
||
not have permission to change to the specified ID.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Setting Groups, Next: Enable/Disable Setuid, Prev: Setting User ID, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.7 Setting the Group IDs
|
||
==========================
|
||
|
||
This section describes the functions for altering the group IDs (real
|
||
and effective) of a process. To use these facilities, you must include
|
||
the header files ‘sys/types.h’ and ‘unistd.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setegid (gid_t NEWGID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function sets the effective group ID of the process to NEWGID,
|
||
provided that the process is allowed to change its group ID. Just
|
||
as with ‘seteuid’, if the process is privileged it may change its
|
||
effective group ID to any value; if it isn’t, but it has a file
|
||
group ID, then it may change to its real group ID or file group ID;
|
||
otherwise it may not change its effective group ID.
|
||
|
||
Note that a process is only privileged if its effective _user_ ID
|
||
is zero. The effective group ID only affects access permissions.
|
||
|
||
The return values and error conditions for ‘setegid’ are the same
|
||
as those for ‘seteuid’.
|
||
|
||
This function is only present if ‘_POSIX_SAVED_IDS’ is defined.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setgid (gid_t NEWGID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function sets both the real and effective group ID of the
|
||
process to NEWGID, provided that the process is privileged. It
|
||
also deletes the file group ID, if any.
|
||
|
||
If the process is not privileged, then ‘setgid’ behaves like
|
||
‘setegid’.
|
||
|
||
The return values and error conditions for ‘setgid’ are the same as
|
||
those for ‘seteuid’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setregid (gid_t RGID, gid_t EGID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function sets the real group ID of the process to RGID and the
|
||
effective group ID to EGID. If RGID is ‘-1’, it means not to
|
||
change the real group ID; likewise if EGID is ‘-1’, it means not to
|
||
change the effective group ID.
|
||
|
||
The ‘setregid’ function is provided for compatibility with 4.3 BSD
|
||
Unix, which does not support file IDs. You can use this function
|
||
to swap the effective and real group IDs of the process.
|
||
(Privileged processes are not limited to this usage.) If file IDs
|
||
are supported, you should use that feature instead of using this
|
||
function. *Note Enable/Disable Setuid::.
|
||
|
||
The return values and error conditions for ‘setregid’ are the same
|
||
as those for ‘setreuid’.
|
||
|
||
‘setuid’ and ‘setgid’ behave differently depending on whether the
|
||
effective user ID at the time is zero. If it is not zero, they behave
|
||
like ‘seteuid’ and ‘setegid’. If it is, they change both effective and
|
||
real IDs and delete the file ID. To avoid confusion, we recommend you
|
||
always use ‘seteuid’ and ‘setegid’ except when you know the effective
|
||
user ID is zero and your intent is to change the persona permanently.
|
||
This case is rare—most of the programs that need it, such as ‘login’ and
|
||
‘su’, have already been written.
|
||
|
||
Note that if your program is setuid to some user other than ‘root’,
|
||
there is no way to drop privileges permanently.
|
||
|
||
The system also lets privileged processes change their supplementary
|
||
group IDs. To use ‘setgroups’ or ‘initgroups’, your programs should
|
||
include the header file ‘grp.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setgroups (size_t COUNT, const gid_t *GROUPS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe lock | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function sets the process’s supplementary group IDs. It can
|
||
only be called from privileged processes. The COUNT argument
|
||
specifies the number of group IDs in the array GROUPS.
|
||
|
||
This function returns ‘0’ if successful and ‘-1’ on error. The
|
||
following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The calling process is not privileged.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int initgroups (const char *USER, gid_t GROUP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt mem fd lock | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘initgroups’ function sets the process’s supplementary group
|
||
IDs to be the normal default for the user name USER. The group
|
||
GROUP is automatically included.
|
||
|
||
This function works by scanning the group database for all the
|
||
groups USER belongs to. It then calls ‘setgroups’ with the list it
|
||
has constructed.
|
||
|
||
The return values and error conditions are the same as for
|
||
‘setgroups’.
|
||
|
||
If you are interested in the groups a particular user belongs to, but
|
||
do not want to change the process’s supplementary group IDs, you can use
|
||
‘getgrouplist’. To use ‘getgrouplist’, your programs should include the
|
||
header file ‘grp.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getgrouplist (const char *USER, gid_t GROUP, gid_t
|
||
*GROUPS, int *NGROUPS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt mem fd lock | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getgrouplist’ function scans the group database for all the
|
||
groups USER belongs to. Up to *NGROUPS group IDs corresponding to
|
||
these groups are stored in the array GROUPS; the return value from
|
||
the function is the number of group IDs actually stored. If
|
||
*NGROUPS is smaller than the total number of groups found, then
|
||
‘getgrouplist’ returns a value of ‘-1’ and stores the actual number
|
||
of groups in *NGROUPS. The group GROUP is automatically included
|
||
in the list of groups returned by ‘getgrouplist’.
|
||
|
||
Here’s how to use ‘getgrouplist’ to read all supplementary groups
|
||
for USER:
|
||
|
||
gid_t *
|
||
supplementary_groups (char *user)
|
||
{
|
||
int ngroups = 16;
|
||
gid_t *groups
|
||
= (gid_t *) xmalloc (ngroups * sizeof (gid_t));
|
||
struct passwd *pw = getpwnam (user);
|
||
|
||
if (pw == NULL)
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (getgrouplist (pw->pw_name, pw->pw_gid, groups, &ngroups) < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
groups = xrealloc (ngroups * sizeof (gid_t));
|
||
getgrouplist (pw->pw_name, pw->pw_gid, groups, &ngroups);
|
||
}
|
||
return groups;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Enable/Disable Setuid, Next: Setuid Program Example, Prev: Setting Groups, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.8 Enabling and Disabling Setuid Access
|
||
=========================================
|
||
|
||
A typical setuid program does not need its special access all of the
|
||
time. It’s a good idea to turn off this access when it isn’t needed, so
|
||
it can’t possibly give unintended access.
|
||
|
||
If the system supports the ‘_POSIX_SAVED_IDS’ feature, you can
|
||
accomplish this with ‘seteuid’. When the game program starts, its real
|
||
user ID is ‘jdoe’, its effective user ID is ‘games’, and its saved user
|
||
ID is also ‘games’. The program should record both user ID values once
|
||
at the beginning, like this:
|
||
|
||
user_user_id = getuid ();
|
||
game_user_id = geteuid ();
|
||
|
||
Then it can turn off game file access with
|
||
|
||
seteuid (user_user_id);
|
||
|
||
and turn it on with
|
||
|
||
seteuid (game_user_id);
|
||
|
||
Throughout this process, the real user ID remains ‘jdoe’ and the file
|
||
user ID remains ‘games’, so the program can always set its effective
|
||
user ID to either one.
|
||
|
||
On other systems that don’t support file user IDs, you can turn
|
||
setuid access on and off by using ‘setreuid’ to swap the real and
|
||
effective user IDs of the process, as follows:
|
||
|
||
setreuid (geteuid (), getuid ());
|
||
|
||
This special case is always allowed—it cannot fail.
|
||
|
||
Why does this have the effect of toggling the setuid access? Suppose
|
||
a game program has just started, and its real user ID is ‘jdoe’ while
|
||
its effective user ID is ‘games’. In this state, the game can write the
|
||
scores file. If it swaps the two uids, the real becomes ‘games’ and the
|
||
effective becomes ‘jdoe’; now the program has only ‘jdoe’ access.
|
||
Another swap brings ‘games’ back to the effective user ID and restores
|
||
access to the scores file.
|
||
|
||
In order to handle both kinds of systems, test for the saved user ID
|
||
feature with a preprocessor conditional, like this:
|
||
|
||
#ifdef _POSIX_SAVED_IDS
|
||
seteuid (user_user_id);
|
||
#else
|
||
setreuid (geteuid (), getuid ());
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Setuid Program Example, Next: Tips for Setuid, Prev: Enable/Disable Setuid, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.9 Setuid Program Example
|
||
===========================
|
||
|
||
Here’s an example showing how to set up a program that changes its
|
||
effective user ID.
|
||
|
||
This is part of a game program called ‘caber-toss’ that manipulates a
|
||
file ‘scores’ that should be writable only by the game program itself.
|
||
The program assumes that its executable file will be installed with the
|
||
setuid bit set and owned by the same user as the ‘scores’ file.
|
||
Typically, a system administrator will set up an account like ‘games’
|
||
for this purpose.
|
||
|
||
The executable file is given mode ‘4755’, so that doing an ‘ls -l’ on
|
||
it produces output like:
|
||
|
||
-rwsr-xr-x 1 games 184422 Jul 30 15:17 caber-toss
|
||
|
||
The setuid bit shows up in the file modes as the ‘s’.
|
||
|
||
The scores file is given mode ‘644’, and doing an ‘ls -l’ on it
|
||
shows:
|
||
|
||
-rw-r--r-- 1 games 0 Jul 31 15:33 scores
|
||
|
||
Here are the parts of the program that show how to set up the changed
|
||
user ID. This program is conditionalized so that it makes use of the
|
||
file IDs feature if it is supported, and otherwise uses ‘setreuid’ to
|
||
swap the effective and real user IDs.
|
||
|
||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Remember the effective and real UIDs. */
|
||
|
||
static uid_t euid, ruid;
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Restore the effective UID to its original value. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
do_setuid (void)
|
||
{
|
||
int status;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef _POSIX_SAVED_IDS
|
||
status = seteuid (euid);
|
||
#else
|
||
status = setreuid (ruid, euid);
|
||
#endif
|
||
if (status < 0) {
|
||
fprintf (stderr, "Couldn't set uid.\n");
|
||
exit (status);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Set the effective UID to the real UID. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
undo_setuid (void)
|
||
{
|
||
int status;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef _POSIX_SAVED_IDS
|
||
status = seteuid (ruid);
|
||
#else
|
||
status = setreuid (euid, ruid);
|
||
#endif
|
||
if (status < 0) {
|
||
fprintf (stderr, "Couldn't set uid.\n");
|
||
exit (status);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Main program. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
main (void)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Remember the real and effective user IDs. */
|
||
ruid = getuid ();
|
||
euid = geteuid ();
|
||
undo_setuid ();
|
||
|
||
/* Do the game and record the score. */
|
||
…
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
Notice how the first thing the ‘main’ function does is to set the
|
||
effective user ID back to the real user ID. This is so that any other
|
||
file accesses that are performed while the user is playing the game use
|
||
the real user ID for determining permissions. Only when the program
|
||
needs to open the scores file does it switch back to the file user ID,
|
||
like this:
|
||
|
||
/* Record the score. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
record_score (int score)
|
||
{
|
||
FILE *stream;
|
||
char *myname;
|
||
|
||
/* Open the scores file. */
|
||
do_setuid ();
|
||
stream = fopen (SCORES_FILE, "a");
|
||
undo_setuid ();
|
||
|
||
/* Write the score to the file. */
|
||
if (stream)
|
||
{
|
||
myname = cuserid (NULL);
|
||
if (score < 0)
|
||
fprintf (stream, "%10s: Couldn't lift the caber.\n", myname);
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (stream, "%10s: %d feet.\n", myname, score);
|
||
fclose (stream);
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return -1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Tips for Setuid, Next: Who Logged In, Prev: Setuid Program Example, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.10 Tips for Writing Setuid Programs
|
||
======================================
|
||
|
||
It is easy for setuid programs to give the user access that isn’t
|
||
intended—in fact, if you want to avoid this, you need to be careful.
|
||
Here are some guidelines for preventing unintended access and minimizing
|
||
its consequences when it does occur:
|
||
|
||
• Don’t have ‘setuid’ programs with privileged user IDs such as
|
||
‘root’ unless it is absolutely necessary. If the resource is
|
||
specific to your particular program, it’s better to define a new,
|
||
nonprivileged user ID or group ID just to manage that resource.
|
||
It’s better if you can write your program to use a special group
|
||
than a special user.
|
||
|
||
• Be cautious about using the ‘exec’ functions in combination with
|
||
changing the effective user ID. Don’t let users of your program
|
||
execute arbitrary programs under a changed user ID. Executing a
|
||
shell is especially bad news. Less obviously, the ‘execlp’ and
|
||
‘execvp’ functions are a potential risk (since the program they
|
||
execute depends on the user’s ‘PATH’ environment variable).
|
||
|
||
If you must ‘exec’ another program under a changed ID, specify an
|
||
absolute file name (*note File Name Resolution::) for the
|
||
executable, and make sure that the protections on that executable
|
||
and _all_ containing directories are such that ordinary users
|
||
cannot replace it with some other program.
|
||
|
||
You should also check the arguments passed to the program to make
|
||
sure they do not have unexpected effects. Likewise, you should
|
||
examine the environment variables. Decide which arguments and
|
||
variables are safe, and reject all others.
|
||
|
||
You should never use ‘system’ in a privileged program, because it
|
||
invokes a shell.
|
||
|
||
• Only use the user ID controlling the resource in the part of the
|
||
program that actually uses that resource. When you’re finished
|
||
with it, restore the effective user ID back to the actual user’s
|
||
user ID. *Note Enable/Disable Setuid::.
|
||
|
||
• If the ‘setuid’ part of your program needs to access other files
|
||
besides the controlled resource, it should verify that the real
|
||
user would ordinarily have permission to access those files. You
|
||
can use the ‘access’ function (*note Access Permission::) to check
|
||
this; it uses the real user and group IDs, rather than the
|
||
effective IDs.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Who Logged In, Next: User Accounting Database, Prev: Tips for Setuid, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.11 Identifying Who Logged In
|
||
===============================
|
||
|
||
You can use the functions listed in this section to determine the login
|
||
name of the user who is running a process, and the name of the user who
|
||
logged in the current session. See also the function ‘getuid’ and
|
||
friends (*note Reading Persona::). How this information is collected by
|
||
the system and how to control/add/remove information from the background
|
||
storage is described in *note User Accounting Database::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getlogin’ function is declared in ‘unistd.h’, while ‘cuserid’
|
||
and ‘L_cuserid’ are declared in ‘stdio.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: char * getlogin (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:getlogin race:utent sig:ALRM timer
|
||
locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock
|
||
fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getlogin’ function returns a pointer to a string containing
|
||
the name of the user logged in on the controlling terminal of the
|
||
process, or a null pointer if this information cannot be
|
||
determined. The string is statically allocated and might be
|
||
overwritten on subsequent calls to this function or to ‘cuserid’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: char * cuserid (char *STRING)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:cuserid/!string locale | AS-Unsafe
|
||
dlopen plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note
|
||
POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘cuserid’ function returns a pointer to a string containing a
|
||
user name associated with the effective ID of the process. If
|
||
STRING is not a null pointer, it should be an array that can hold
|
||
at least ‘L_cuserid’ characters; the string is returned in this
|
||
array. Otherwise, a pointer to a string in a static area is
|
||
returned. This string is statically allocated and might be
|
||
overwritten on subsequent calls to this function or to ‘getlogin’.
|
||
|
||
The use of this function is deprecated since it is marked to be
|
||
withdrawn in XPG4.2 and has already been removed from newer
|
||
revisions of POSIX.1.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: int L_cuserid
|
||
|
||
An integer constant that indicates how long an array you might need
|
||
to store a user name.
|
||
|
||
These functions let your program identify positively the user who is
|
||
running or the user who logged in this session. (These can differ when
|
||
setuid programs are involved; see *note Process Persona::.) The user
|
||
cannot do anything to fool these functions.
|
||
|
||
For most purposes, it is more useful to use the environment variable
|
||
‘LOGNAME’ to find out who the user is. This is more flexible precisely
|
||
because the user can set ‘LOGNAME’ arbitrarily. *Note Standard
|
||
Environment::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: User Accounting Database, Next: User Database, Prev: Who Logged In, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.12 The User Accounting Database
|
||
==================================
|
||
|
||
Most Unix-like operating systems keep track of logged in users by
|
||
maintaining a user accounting database. This user accounting database
|
||
stores for each terminal, who has logged on, at what time, the process
|
||
ID of the user’s login shell, etc., etc., but also stores information
|
||
about the run level of the system, the time of the last system reboot,
|
||
and possibly more.
|
||
|
||
The user accounting database typically lives in ‘/etc/utmp’,
|
||
‘/var/adm/utmp’ or ‘/var/run/utmp’. However, these files should *never*
|
||
be accessed directly. For reading information from and writing
|
||
information to the user accounting database, the functions described in
|
||
this section should be used.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Manipulating the Database:: Scanning and modifying the user
|
||
accounting database.
|
||
* XPG Functions:: A standardized way for doing the same thing.
|
||
* Logging In and Out:: Functions from BSD that modify the user
|
||
accounting database.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Manipulating the Database, Next: XPG Functions, Up: User Accounting Database
|
||
|
||
30.12.1 Manipulating the User Accounting Database
|
||
-------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
These functions and the corresponding data structures are declared in
|
||
the header file ‘utmp.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct exit_status
|
||
|
||
The ‘exit_status’ data structure is used to hold information about
|
||
the exit status of processes marked as ‘DEAD_PROCESS’ in the user
|
||
accounting database.
|
||
|
||
‘short int e_termination’
|
||
The exit status of the process.
|
||
|
||
‘short int e_exit’
|
||
The exit status of the process.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct utmp
|
||
The ‘utmp’ data structure is used to hold information about entries
|
||
in the user accounting database. On GNU systems it has the
|
||
following members:
|
||
|
||
‘short int ut_type’
|
||
Specifies the type of login; one of ‘EMPTY’, ‘RUN_LVL’,
|
||
‘BOOT_TIME’, ‘OLD_TIME’, ‘NEW_TIME’, ‘INIT_PROCESS’,
|
||
‘LOGIN_PROCESS’, ‘USER_PROCESS’, ‘DEAD_PROCESS’ or
|
||
‘ACCOUNTING’.
|
||
|
||
‘pid_t ut_pid’
|
||
The process ID number of the login process.
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_line[]’
|
||
The device name of the tty (without ‘/dev/’).
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_id[]’
|
||
The inittab ID of the process.
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_user[]’
|
||
The user’s login name.
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_host[]’
|
||
The name of the host from which the user logged in.
|
||
|
||
‘struct exit_status ut_exit’
|
||
The exit status of a process marked as ‘DEAD_PROCESS’.
|
||
|
||
‘long ut_session’
|
||
The Session ID, used for windowing.
|
||
|
||
‘struct timeval ut_tv’
|
||
Time the entry was made. For entries of type ‘OLD_TIME’ this
|
||
is the time when the system clock changed, and for entries of
|
||
type ‘NEW_TIME’ this is the time the system clock was set to.
|
||
|
||
‘int32_t ut_addr_v6[4]’
|
||
The Internet address of a remote host.
|
||
|
||
The ‘ut_type’, ‘ut_pid’, ‘ut_id’, ‘ut_tv’, and ‘ut_host’ fields are
|
||
not available on all systems. Portable applications therefore should be
|
||
prepared for these situations. To help do this the ‘utmp.h’ header
|
||
provides macros ‘_HAVE_UT_TYPE’, ‘_HAVE_UT_PID’, ‘_HAVE_UT_ID’,
|
||
‘_HAVE_UT_TV’, and ‘_HAVE_UT_HOST’ if the respective field is available.
|
||
The programmer can handle the situations by using ‘#ifdef’ in the
|
||
program code.
|
||
|
||
The following macros are defined for use as values for the ‘ut_type’
|
||
member of the ‘utmp’ structure. The values are integer constants.
|
||
|
||
‘EMPTY’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to indicate that the entry contains no valid
|
||
user accounting information.
|
||
|
||
‘RUN_LVL’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the system’s runlevel.
|
||
|
||
‘BOOT_TIME’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the time of system boot.
|
||
|
||
‘OLD_TIME’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the time when the system clock
|
||
changed.
|
||
|
||
‘NEW_TIME’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the time after the system clock
|
||
changed.
|
||
|
||
‘INIT_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify a process spawned by the init
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
‘LOGIN_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the session leader of a logged in
|
||
user.
|
||
|
||
‘USER_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify a user process.
|
||
|
||
‘DEAD_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify a terminated process.
|
||
|
||
‘ACCOUNTING’
|
||
|
||
???
|
||
|
||
The size of the ‘ut_line’, ‘ut_id’, ‘ut_user’ and ‘ut_host’ arrays
|
||
can be found using the ‘sizeof’ operator.
|
||
|
||
Many older systems have, instead of an ‘ut_tv’ member, an ‘ut_time’
|
||
member, usually of type ‘time_t’, for representing the time associated
|
||
with the entry. Therefore, for backwards compatibility only, ‘utmp.h’
|
||
defines ‘ut_time’ as an alias for ‘ut_tv.tv_sec’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void setutent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe
|
||
lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function opens the user accounting database to begin scanning
|
||
it. You can then call ‘getutent’, ‘getutid’ or ‘getutline’ to read
|
||
entries and ‘pututline’ to write entries.
|
||
|
||
If the database is already open, it resets the input to the
|
||
beginning of the database.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmp * getutent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe init race:utent race:utentbuf sig:ALRM
|
||
timer | AS-Unsafe heap lock | AC-Unsafe lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getutent’ function reads the next entry from the user
|
||
accounting database. It returns a pointer to the entry, which is
|
||
statically allocated and may be overwritten by subsequent calls to
|
||
‘getutent’. You must copy the contents of the structure if you
|
||
wish to save the information or you can use the ‘getutent_r’
|
||
function which stores the data in a user-provided buffer.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer is returned in case no further entry is available.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void endutent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe
|
||
lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function closes the user accounting database.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmp * getutid (const struct utmp *ID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe init race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe
|
||
lock heap | AC-Unsafe lock mem fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function searches forward from the current point in the
|
||
database for an entry that matches ID. If the ‘ut_type’ member of
|
||
the ID structure is one of ‘RUN_LVL’, ‘BOOT_TIME’, ‘OLD_TIME’ or
|
||
‘NEW_TIME’ the entries match if the ‘ut_type’ members are
|
||
identical. If the ‘ut_type’ member of the ID structure is
|
||
‘INIT_PROCESS’, ‘LOGIN_PROCESS’, ‘USER_PROCESS’ or ‘DEAD_PROCESS’,
|
||
the entries match if the ‘ut_type’ member of the entry read from
|
||
the database is one of these four, and the ‘ut_id’ members match.
|
||
However if the ‘ut_id’ member of either the ID structure or the
|
||
entry read from the database is empty it checks if the ‘ut_line’
|
||
members match instead. If a matching entry is found, ‘getutid’
|
||
returns a pointer to the entry, which is statically allocated, and
|
||
may be overwritten by a subsequent call to ‘getutent’, ‘getutid’ or
|
||
‘getutline’. You must copy the contents of the structure if you
|
||
wish to save the information.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer is returned in case the end of the database is
|
||
reached without a match.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getutid’ function may cache the last read entry. Therefore,
|
||
if you are using ‘getutid’ to search for multiple occurrences, it
|
||
is necessary to zero out the static data after each call.
|
||
Otherwise ‘getutid’ could just return a pointer to the same entry
|
||
over and over again.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmp * getutline (const struct utmp *LINE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe init race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe
|
||
heap lock | AC-Unsafe lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function searches forward from the current point in the
|
||
database until it finds an entry whose ‘ut_type’ value is
|
||
‘LOGIN_PROCESS’ or ‘USER_PROCESS’, and whose ‘ut_line’ member
|
||
matches the ‘ut_line’ member of the LINE structure. If it finds
|
||
such an entry, it returns a pointer to the entry which is
|
||
statically allocated, and may be overwritten by a subsequent call
|
||
to ‘getutent’, ‘getutid’ or ‘getutline’. You must copy the
|
||
contents of the structure if you wish to save the information.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer is returned in case the end of the database is
|
||
reached without a match.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getutline’ function may cache the last read entry. Therefore
|
||
if you are using ‘getutline’ to search for multiple occurrences, it
|
||
is necessary to zero out the static data after each call.
|
||
Otherwise ‘getutline’ could just return a pointer to the same entry
|
||
over and over again.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmp * pututline (const struct utmp *UTMP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
| AC-Unsafe lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘pututline’ function inserts the entry ‘*UTMP’ at the
|
||
appropriate place in the user accounting database. If it finds
|
||
that it is not already at the correct place in the database, it
|
||
uses ‘getutid’ to search for the position to insert the entry,
|
||
however this will not modify the static structure returned by
|
||
‘getutent’, ‘getutid’ and ‘getutline’. If this search fails, the
|
||
entry is appended to the database.
|
||
|
||
The ‘pututline’ function returns a pointer to a copy of the entry
|
||
inserted in the user accounting database, or a null pointer if the
|
||
entry could not be added. The following ‘errno’ error conditions
|
||
are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The process does not have the appropriate privileges; you
|
||
cannot modify the user accounting database.
|
||
|
||
All the ‘get*’ functions mentioned before store the information they
|
||
return in a static buffer. This can be a problem in multi-threaded
|
||
programs since the data returned for the request is overwritten by the
|
||
return value data in another thread. Therefore the GNU C Library
|
||
provides as extensions three more functions which return the data in a
|
||
user-provided buffer.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getutent_r (struct utmp *BUFFER, struct utmp **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
| AC-Unsafe lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getutent_r’ is equivalent to the ‘getutent’ function. It
|
||
returns the next entry from the database. But instead of storing
|
||
the information in a static buffer it stores it in the buffer
|
||
pointed to by the parameter BUFFER.
|
||
|
||
If the call was successful, the function returns ‘0’ and the
|
||
pointer variable pointed to by the parameter RESULT contains a
|
||
pointer to the buffer which contains the result (this is most
|
||
probably the same value as BUFFER). If something went wrong during
|
||
the execution of ‘getutent_r’ the function returns ‘-1’.
|
||
|
||
This function is a GNU extension.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getutid_r (const struct utmp *ID, struct utmp *BUFFER,
|
||
struct utmp **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
| AC-Unsafe lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function retrieves just like ‘getutid’ the next entry matching
|
||
the information stored in ID. But the result is stored in the
|
||
buffer pointed to by the parameter BUFFER.
|
||
|
||
If successful the function returns ‘0’ and the pointer variable
|
||
pointed to by the parameter RESULT contains a pointer to the buffer
|
||
with the result (probably the same as RESULT. If not successful
|
||
the function return ‘-1’.
|
||
|
||
This function is a GNU extension.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getutline_r (const struct utmp *LINE, struct utmp
|
||
*BUFFER, struct utmp **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
| AC-Unsafe lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function retrieves just like ‘getutline’ the next entry
|
||
matching the information stored in LINE. But the result is stored
|
||
in the buffer pointed to by the parameter BUFFER.
|
||
|
||
If successful the function returns ‘0’ and the pointer variable
|
||
pointed to by the parameter RESULT contains a pointer to the buffer
|
||
with the result (probably the same as RESULT. If not successful
|
||
the function return ‘-1’.
|
||
|
||
This function is a GNU extension.
|
||
|
||
In addition to the user accounting database, most systems keep a
|
||
number of similar databases. For example most systems keep a log file
|
||
with all previous logins (usually in ‘/etc/wtmp’ or ‘/var/log/wtmp’).
|
||
|
||
For specifying which database to examine, the following function
|
||
should be used.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int utmpname (const char *FILE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent | AS-Unsafe lock heap |
|
||
AC-Unsafe lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘utmpname’ function changes the name of the database to be
|
||
examined to FILE, and closes any previously opened database. By
|
||
default ‘getutent’, ‘getutid’, ‘getutline’ and ‘pututline’ read
|
||
from and write to the user accounting database.
|
||
|
||
The following macros are defined for use as the FILE argument:
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: char * _PATH_UTMP
|
||
This macro is used to specify the user accounting database.
|
||
|
||
-- Macro: char * _PATH_WTMP
|
||
This macro is used to specify the user accounting log file.
|
||
|
||
The ‘utmpname’ function returns a value of ‘0’ if the new name was
|
||
successfully stored, and a value of ‘-1’ to indicate an error.
|
||
Note that ‘utmpname’ does not try to open the database, and that
|
||
therefore the return value does not say anything about whether the
|
||
database can be successfully opened.
|
||
|
||
Specially for maintaining log-like databases the GNU C Library
|
||
provides the following function:
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void updwtmp (const char *WTMP_FILE, const struct utmp
|
||
*UTMP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe | AC-Unsafe fd
|
||
| *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘updwtmp’ function appends the entry *UTMP to the database
|
||
specified by WTMP_FILE. For possible values for the WTMP_FILE
|
||
argument see the ‘utmpname’ function.
|
||
|
||
*Portability Note:* Although many operating systems provide a subset
|
||
of these functions, they are not standardized. There are often subtle
|
||
differences in the return types, and there are considerable differences
|
||
between the various definitions of ‘struct utmp’. When programming for
|
||
the GNU C Library, it is probably best to stick with the functions
|
||
described in this section. If however, you want your program to be
|
||
portable, consider using the XPG functions described in *note XPG
|
||
Functions::, or take a look at the BSD compatible functions in *note
|
||
Logging In and Out::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: XPG Functions, Next: Logging In and Out, Prev: Manipulating the Database, Up: User Accounting Database
|
||
|
||
30.12.2 XPG User Accounting Database Functions
|
||
----------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
These functions, described in the X/Open Portability Guide, are declared
|
||
in the header file ‘utmpx.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct utmpx
|
||
The ‘utmpx’ data structure contains at least the following members:
|
||
|
||
‘short int ut_type’
|
||
Specifies the type of login; one of ‘EMPTY’, ‘RUN_LVL’,
|
||
‘BOOT_TIME’, ‘OLD_TIME’, ‘NEW_TIME’, ‘INIT_PROCESS’,
|
||
‘LOGIN_PROCESS’, ‘USER_PROCESS’ or ‘DEAD_PROCESS’.
|
||
|
||
‘pid_t ut_pid’
|
||
The process ID number of the login process.
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_line[]’
|
||
The device name of the tty (without ‘/dev/’).
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_id[]’
|
||
The inittab ID of the process.
|
||
|
||
‘char ut_user[]’
|
||
The user’s login name.
|
||
|
||
‘struct timeval ut_tv’
|
||
Time the entry was made. For entries of type ‘OLD_TIME’ this
|
||
is the time when the system clock changed, and for entries of
|
||
type ‘NEW_TIME’ this is the time the system clock was set to.
|
||
In the GNU C Library, ‘struct utmpx’ is identical to ‘struct utmp’
|
||
except for the fact that including ‘utmpx.h’ does not make visible
|
||
the declaration of ‘struct exit_status’.
|
||
|
||
The following macros are defined for use as values for the ‘ut_type’
|
||
member of the ‘utmpx’ structure. The values are integer constants and
|
||
are, in the GNU C Library, identical to the definitions in ‘utmp.h’.
|
||
|
||
‘EMPTY’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to indicate that the entry contains no valid
|
||
user accounting information.
|
||
|
||
‘RUN_LVL’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the system’s runlevel.
|
||
|
||
‘BOOT_TIME’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the time of system boot.
|
||
|
||
‘OLD_TIME’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the time when the system clock
|
||
changed.
|
||
|
||
‘NEW_TIME’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the time after the system clock
|
||
changed.
|
||
|
||
‘INIT_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify a process spawned by the init
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
‘LOGIN_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify the session leader of a logged in
|
||
user.
|
||
|
||
‘USER_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify a user process.
|
||
|
||
‘DEAD_PROCESS’
|
||
|
||
This macro is used to identify a terminated process.
|
||
|
||
The size of the ‘ut_line’, ‘ut_id’ and ‘ut_user’ arrays can be found
|
||
using the ‘sizeof’ operator.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void setutxent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe
|
||
lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘setutent’. In the GNU C Library it is
|
||
simply an alias for ‘setutent’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmpx * getutxent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe init race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe
|
||
heap lock | AC-Unsafe lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getutxent’ function is similar to ‘getutent’, but returns a
|
||
pointer to a ‘struct utmpx’ instead of ‘struct utmp’. In the GNU C
|
||
Library it simply is an alias for ‘getutent’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void endutxent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent | AS-Unsafe lock | AC-Unsafe
|
||
lock | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘endutent’. In the GNU C Library it is
|
||
simply an alias for ‘endutent’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmpx * getutxid (const struct utmpx *ID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe init race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe
|
||
lock heap | AC-Unsafe lock mem fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getutid’, but uses ‘struct utmpx’
|
||
instead of ‘struct utmp’. In the GNU C Library it is simply an
|
||
alias for ‘getutid’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmpx * getutxline (const struct utmpx *LINE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe init race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe
|
||
heap lock | AC-Unsafe lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getutid’, but uses ‘struct utmpx’
|
||
instead of ‘struct utmp’. In the GNU C Library it is simply an
|
||
alias for ‘getutline’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct utmpx * pututxline (const struct utmpx *UTMP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
| AC-Unsafe lock fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘pututxline’ function is functionally identical to ‘pututline’,
|
||
but uses ‘struct utmpx’ instead of ‘struct utmp’. In the GNU C
|
||
Library, ‘pututxline’ is simply an alias for ‘pututline’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int utmpxname (const char *FILE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent | AS-Unsafe lock heap |
|
||
AC-Unsafe lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘utmpxname’ function is functionally identical to ‘utmpname’.
|
||
In the GNU C Library, ‘utmpxname’ is simply an alias for
|
||
‘utmpname’.
|
||
|
||
You can translate between a traditional ‘struct utmp’ and an XPG
|
||
‘struct utmpx’ with the following functions. In the GNU C Library,
|
||
these functions are merely copies, since the two structures are
|
||
identical.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getutmp (const struct utmpx *UTMPX, struct utmp *UTMP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘getutmp’ copies the information, insofar as the structures are
|
||
compatible, from UTMPX to UTMP.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getutmpx (const struct utmp *UTMP, struct utmpx
|
||
*UTMPX)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘getutmpx’ copies the information, insofar as the structures are
|
||
compatible, from UTMP to UTMPX.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Logging In and Out, Prev: XPG Functions, Up: User Accounting Database
|
||
|
||
30.12.3 Logging In and Out
|
||
--------------------------
|
||
|
||
These functions, derived from BSD, are available in the separate
|
||
‘libutil’ library, and declared in ‘utmp.h’.
|
||
|
||
Note that the ‘ut_user’ member of ‘struct utmp’ is called ‘ut_name’
|
||
in BSD. Therefore, ‘ut_name’ is defined as an alias for ‘ut_user’ in
|
||
‘utmp.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int login_tty (int FILEDES)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:ttyname | AS-Unsafe heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function makes FILEDES the controlling terminal of the current
|
||
process, redirects standard input, standard output and standard
|
||
error output to this terminal, and closes FILEDES.
|
||
|
||
This function returns ‘0’ on successful completion, and ‘-1’ on
|
||
error.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void login (const struct utmp *ENTRY)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
heap | AC-Unsafe lock corrupt fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘login’ functions inserts an entry into the user accounting
|
||
database. The ‘ut_line’ member is set to the name of the terminal
|
||
on standard input. If standard input is not a terminal ‘login’
|
||
uses standard output or standard error output to determine the name
|
||
of the terminal. If ‘struct utmp’ has a ‘ut_type’ member, ‘login’
|
||
sets it to ‘USER_PROCESS’, and if there is an ‘ut_pid’ member, it
|
||
will be set to the process ID of the current process. The
|
||
remaining entries are copied from ENTRY.
|
||
|
||
A copy of the entry is written to the user accounting log file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int logout (const char *UT_LINE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:utent sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe lock
|
||
heap | AC-Unsafe lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function modifies the user accounting database to indicate
|
||
that the user on UT_LINE has logged out.
|
||
|
||
The ‘logout’ function returns ‘1’ if the entry was successfully
|
||
written to the database, or ‘0’ on error.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void logwtmp (const char *UT_LINE, const char *UT_NAME,
|
||
const char *UT_HOST)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe sig:ALRM timer | AS-Unsafe | AC-Unsafe fd
|
||
| *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘logwtmp’ function appends an entry to the user accounting log
|
||
file, for the current time and the information provided in the
|
||
UT_LINE, UT_NAME and UT_HOST arguments.
|
||
|
||
*Portability Note:* The BSD ‘struct utmp’ only has the ‘ut_line’,
|
||
‘ut_name’, ‘ut_host’ and ‘ut_time’ members. Older systems do not even
|
||
have the ‘ut_host’ member.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: User Database, Next: Group Database, Prev: User Accounting Database, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.13 User Database
|
||
===================
|
||
|
||
This section describes how to search and scan the database of registered
|
||
users. The database itself is kept in the file ‘/etc/passwd’ on most
|
||
systems, but on some systems a special network server gives access to
|
||
it.
|
||
|
||
Historically, this database included one-way hashes of user
|
||
passphrases (*note Passphrase Storage::) as well as public information
|
||
about each user (such as their user ID and full name). Many of the
|
||
functions and data structures associated with this database, and the
|
||
filename ‘/etc/passwd’ itself, reflect this history. However, the
|
||
information in this database is available to all users, and it is no
|
||
longer considered safe to make passphrase hashes available to all users,
|
||
so they have been moved to a “shadow” database that can only be accessed
|
||
with special privileges.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* User Data Structure:: What each user record contains.
|
||
* Lookup User:: How to look for a particular user.
|
||
* Scanning All Users:: Scanning the list of all users, one by one.
|
||
* Writing a User Entry:: How a program can rewrite a user’s record.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: User Data Structure, Next: Lookup User, Up: User Database
|
||
|
||
30.13.1 The Data Structure that Describes a User
|
||
------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The functions and data structures for accessing the system user database
|
||
are declared in the header file ‘pwd.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct passwd
|
||
|
||
The ‘passwd’ data structure is used to hold information about
|
||
entries in the system user data base. It has at least the
|
||
following members:
|
||
|
||
‘char *pw_name’
|
||
The user’s login name.
|
||
|
||
‘char *pw_passwd’
|
||
Historically, this field would hold the one-way hash of the
|
||
user’s passphrase. Nowadays, it will almost always be the
|
||
single character ‘x’, indicating that the hash is in the
|
||
shadow database.
|
||
|
||
‘uid_t pw_uid’
|
||
The user ID number.
|
||
|
||
‘gid_t pw_gid’
|
||
The user’s default group ID number.
|
||
|
||
‘char *pw_gecos’
|
||
A string typically containing the user’s real name, and
|
||
possibly other information such as a phone number.
|
||
|
||
‘char *pw_dir’
|
||
The user’s home directory, or initial working directory. This
|
||
might be a null pointer, in which case the interpretation is
|
||
system-dependent.
|
||
|
||
‘char *pw_shell’
|
||
The user’s default shell, or the initial program run when the
|
||
user logs in. This might be a null pointer, indicating that
|
||
the system default should be used.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Lookup User, Next: Scanning All Users, Prev: User Data Structure, Up: User Database
|
||
|
||
30.13.2 Looking Up One User
|
||
---------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can search the system user database for information about a specific
|
||
user using ‘getpwuid’ or ‘getpwnam’. These functions are declared in
|
||
‘pwd.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct passwd * getpwuid (uid_t UID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:pwuid locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns a pointer to a statically-allocated structure
|
||
containing information about the user whose user ID is UID. This
|
||
structure may be overwritten on subsequent calls to ‘getpwuid’.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer value indicates there is no user in the data base
|
||
with user ID UID.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getpwuid_r (uid_t UID, struct passwd *RESULT_BUF, char
|
||
*BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN, struct passwd **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getpwuid’ in that it returns
|
||
information about the user whose user ID is UID. However, it fills
|
||
the user supplied structure pointed to by RESULT_BUF with the
|
||
information instead of using a static buffer. The first BUFLEN
|
||
bytes of the additional buffer pointed to by BUFFER are used to
|
||
contain additional information, normally strings which are pointed
|
||
to by the elements of the result structure.
|
||
|
||
If a user with ID UID is found, the pointer returned in RESULT
|
||
points to the record which contains the wanted data (i.e., RESULT
|
||
contains the value RESULT_BUF). If no user is found or if an error
|
||
occurred, the pointer returned in RESULT is a null pointer. The
|
||
function returns zero or an error code. If the buffer BUFFER is
|
||
too small to contain all the needed information, the error code
|
||
‘ERANGE’ is returned and ‘errno’ is set to ‘ERANGE’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct passwd * getpwnam (const char *NAME)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:pwnam locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns a pointer to a statically-allocated structure
|
||
containing information about the user whose user name is NAME.
|
||
This structure may be overwritten on subsequent calls to
|
||
‘getpwnam’.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer return indicates there is no user named NAME.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getpwnam_r (const char *NAME, struct passwd
|
||
*RESULT_BUF, char *BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN, struct passwd
|
||
**RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getpwnam’ in that it returns
|
||
information about the user whose user name is NAME. However, like
|
||
‘getpwuid_r’, it fills the user supplied buffers in RESULT_BUF and
|
||
BUFFER with the information instead of using a static buffer.
|
||
|
||
The return values are the same as for ‘getpwuid_r’.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Scanning All Users, Next: Writing a User Entry, Prev: Lookup User, Up: User Database
|
||
|
||
30.13.3 Scanning the List of All Users
|
||
--------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
This section explains how a program can read the list of all users in
|
||
the system, one user at a time. The functions described here are
|
||
declared in ‘pwd.h’.
|
||
|
||
You can use the ‘fgetpwent’ function to read user entries from a
|
||
particular file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct passwd * fgetpwent (FILE *STREAM)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fpwent | AS-Unsafe corrupt lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function reads the next user entry from STREAM and returns a
|
||
pointer to the entry. The structure is statically allocated and is
|
||
rewritten on subsequent calls to ‘fgetpwent’. You must copy the
|
||
contents of the structure if you wish to save the information.
|
||
|
||
The stream must correspond to a file in the same format as the
|
||
standard user database file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int fgetpwent_r (FILE *STREAM, struct passwd *RESULT_BUF,
|
||
char *BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN, struct passwd **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe corrupt | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock
|
||
| *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘fgetpwent’ in that it reads the next
|
||
user entry from STREAM. But the result is returned in the
|
||
structure pointed to by RESULT_BUF. The first BUFLEN bytes of the
|
||
additional buffer pointed to by BUFFER are used to contain
|
||
additional information, normally strings which are pointed to by
|
||
the elements of the result structure.
|
||
|
||
The stream must correspond to a file in the same format as the
|
||
standard user database file.
|
||
|
||
If the function returns zero RESULT points to the structure with
|
||
the wanted data (normally this is in RESULT_BUF). If errors
|
||
occurred the return value is nonzero and RESULT contains a null
|
||
pointer.
|
||
|
||
The way to scan all the entries in the user database is with
|
||
‘setpwent’, ‘getpwent’, and ‘endpwent’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void setpwent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:pwent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function initializes a stream which ‘getpwent’ and
|
||
‘getpwent_r’ use to read the user database.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct passwd * getpwent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:pwent race:pwentbuf locale |
|
||
AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem |
|
||
*Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getpwent’ function reads the next entry from the stream
|
||
initialized by ‘setpwent’. It returns a pointer to the entry. The
|
||
structure is statically allocated and is rewritten on subsequent
|
||
calls to ‘getpwent’. You must copy the contents of the structure
|
||
if you wish to save the information.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer is returned when no more entries are available.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getpwent_r (struct passwd *RESULT_BUF, char *BUFFER,
|
||
size_t BUFLEN, struct passwd **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:pwent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getpwent’ in that it returns the next
|
||
entry from the stream initialized by ‘setpwent’. Like
|
||
‘fgetpwent_r’, it uses the user-supplied buffers in RESULT_BUF and
|
||
BUFFER to return the information requested.
|
||
|
||
The return values are the same as for ‘fgetpwent_r’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void endpwent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:pwent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function closes the internal stream used by ‘getpwent’ or
|
||
‘getpwent_r’.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Writing a User Entry, Prev: Scanning All Users, Up: User Database
|
||
|
||
30.13.4 Writing a User Entry
|
||
----------------------------
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int putpwent (const struct passwd *P, FILE *STREAM)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt | AC-Unsafe lock
|
||
corrupt | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function writes the user entry ‘*P’ to the stream STREAM, in
|
||
the format used for the standard user database file. The return
|
||
value is zero on success and nonzero on failure.
|
||
|
||
This function exists for compatibility with SVID. We recommend that
|
||
you avoid using it, because it makes sense only on the assumption
|
||
that the ‘struct passwd’ structure has no members except the
|
||
standard ones; on a system which merges the traditional Unix data
|
||
base with other extended information about users, adding an entry
|
||
using this function would inevitably leave out much of the
|
||
important information.
|
||
|
||
The group and user ID fields are left empty if the group or user
|
||
name starts with a - or +.
|
||
|
||
The function ‘putpwent’ is declared in ‘pwd.h’.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Group Database, Next: Database Example, Prev: User Database, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.14 Group Database
|
||
====================
|
||
|
||
This section describes how to search and scan the database of registered
|
||
groups. The database itself is kept in the file ‘/etc/group’ on most
|
||
systems, but on some systems a special network service provides access
|
||
to it.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Group Data Structure:: What each group record contains.
|
||
* Lookup Group:: How to look for a particular group.
|
||
* Scanning All Groups:: Scanning the list of all groups.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Group Data Structure, Next: Lookup Group, Up: Group Database
|
||
|
||
30.14.1 The Data Structure for a Group
|
||
--------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The functions and data structures for accessing the system group
|
||
database are declared in the header file ‘grp.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct group
|
||
|
||
The ‘group’ structure is used to hold information about an entry in
|
||
the system group database. It has at least the following members:
|
||
|
||
‘char *gr_name’
|
||
The name of the group.
|
||
|
||
‘gid_t gr_gid’
|
||
The group ID of the group.
|
||
|
||
‘char **gr_mem’
|
||
A vector of pointers to the names of users in the group. Each
|
||
user name is a null-terminated string, and the vector itself
|
||
is terminated by a null pointer.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Lookup Group, Next: Scanning All Groups, Prev: Group Data Structure, Up: Group Database
|
||
|
||
30.14.2 Looking Up One Group
|
||
----------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can search the group database for information about a specific group
|
||
using ‘getgrgid’ or ‘getgrnam’. These functions are declared in
|
||
‘grp.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct group * getgrgid (gid_t GID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:grgid locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns a pointer to a statically-allocated structure
|
||
containing information about the group whose group ID is GID. This
|
||
structure may be overwritten by subsequent calls to ‘getgrgid’.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer indicates there is no group with ID GID.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getgrgid_r (gid_t GID, struct group *RESULT_BUF, char
|
||
*BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN, struct group **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getgrgid’ in that it returns
|
||
information about the group whose group ID is GID. However, it
|
||
fills the user supplied structure pointed to by RESULT_BUF with the
|
||
information instead of using a static buffer. The first BUFLEN
|
||
bytes of the additional buffer pointed to by BUFFER are used to
|
||
contain additional information, normally strings which are pointed
|
||
to by the elements of the result structure.
|
||
|
||
If a group with ID GID is found, the pointer returned in RESULT
|
||
points to the record which contains the wanted data (i.e., RESULT
|
||
contains the value RESULT_BUF). If no group is found or if an
|
||
error occurred, the pointer returned in RESULT is a null pointer.
|
||
The function returns zero or an error code. If the buffer BUFFER
|
||
is too small to contain all the needed information, the error code
|
||
‘ERANGE’ is returned and ‘errno’ is set to ‘ERANGE’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct group * getgrnam (const char *NAME)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:grnam locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns a pointer to a statically-allocated structure
|
||
containing information about the group whose group name is NAME.
|
||
This structure may be overwritten by subsequent calls to
|
||
‘getgrnam’.
|
||
|
||
A null pointer indicates there is no group named NAME.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getgrnam_r (const char *NAME, struct group
|
||
*RESULT_BUF, char *BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN, struct group
|
||
**RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getgrnam’ in that it returns
|
||
information about the group whose group name is NAME. Like
|
||
‘getgrgid_r’, it uses the user supplied buffers in RESULT_BUF and
|
||
BUFFER, not a static buffer.
|
||
|
||
The return values are the same as for ‘getgrgid_r’.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Scanning All Groups, Prev: Lookup Group, Up: Group Database
|
||
|
||
30.14.3 Scanning the List of All Groups
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
This section explains how a program can read the list of all groups in
|
||
the system, one group at a time. The functions described here are
|
||
declared in ‘grp.h’.
|
||
|
||
You can use the ‘fgetgrent’ function to read group entries from a
|
||
particular file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct group * fgetgrent (FILE *STREAM)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fgrent | AS-Unsafe corrupt lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘fgetgrent’ function reads the next entry from STREAM. It
|
||
returns a pointer to the entry. The structure is statically
|
||
allocated and is overwritten on subsequent calls to ‘fgetgrent’.
|
||
You must copy the contents of the structure if you wish to save the
|
||
information.
|
||
|
||
The stream must correspond to a file in the same format as the
|
||
standard group database file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int fgetgrent_r (FILE *STREAM, struct group *RESULT_BUF,
|
||
char *BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN, struct group **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe corrupt | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock
|
||
| *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘fgetgrent’ in that it reads the next
|
||
user entry from STREAM. But the result is returned in the
|
||
structure pointed to by RESULT_BUF. The first BUFLEN bytes of the
|
||
additional buffer pointed to by BUFFER are used to contain
|
||
additional information, normally strings which are pointed to by
|
||
the elements of the result structure.
|
||
|
||
This stream must correspond to a file in the same format as the
|
||
standard group database file.
|
||
|
||
If the function returns zero RESULT points to the structure with
|
||
the wanted data (normally this is in RESULT_BUF). If errors
|
||
occurred the return value is non-zero and RESULT contains a null
|
||
pointer.
|
||
|
||
The way to scan all the entries in the group database is with
|
||
‘setgrent’, ‘getgrent’, and ‘endgrent’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void setgrent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:grent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function initializes a stream for reading from the group data
|
||
base. You use this stream by calling ‘getgrent’ or ‘getgrent_r’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct group * getgrent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:grent race:grentbuf locale |
|
||
AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem |
|
||
*Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getgrent’ function reads the next entry from the stream
|
||
initialized by ‘setgrent’. It returns a pointer to the entry. The
|
||
structure is statically allocated and is overwritten on subsequent
|
||
calls to ‘getgrent’. You must copy the contents of the structure
|
||
if you wish to save the information.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getgrent_r (struct group *RESULT_BUF, char *BUFFER,
|
||
size_t BUFLEN, struct group **RESULT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:grent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getgrent’ in that it returns the next
|
||
entry from the stream initialized by ‘setgrent’. Like
|
||
‘fgetgrent_r’, it places the result in user-supplied buffers
|
||
pointed to by RESULT_BUF and BUFFER.
|
||
|
||
If the function returns zero RESULT contains a pointer to the data
|
||
(normally equal to RESULT_BUF). If errors occurred the return
|
||
value is non-zero and RESULT contains a null pointer.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void endgrent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:grent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function closes the internal stream used by ‘getgrent’ or
|
||
‘getgrent_r’.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Database Example, Next: Netgroup Database, Prev: Group Database, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.15 User and Group Database Example
|
||
=====================================
|
||
|
||
Here is an example program showing the use of the system database
|
||
inquiry functions. The program prints some information about the user
|
||
running the program.
|
||
|
||
|
||
#include <grp.h>
|
||
#include <pwd.h>
|
||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
main (void)
|
||
{
|
||
uid_t me;
|
||
struct passwd *my_passwd;
|
||
struct group *my_group;
|
||
char **members;
|
||
|
||
/* Get information about the user ID. */
|
||
me = getuid ();
|
||
my_passwd = getpwuid (me);
|
||
if (!my_passwd)
|
||
{
|
||
printf ("Couldn't find out about user %d.\n", (int) me);
|
||
exit (EXIT_FAILURE);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print the information. */
|
||
printf ("I am %s.\n", my_passwd->pw_gecos);
|
||
printf ("My login name is %s.\n", my_passwd->pw_name);
|
||
printf ("My uid is %d.\n", (int) (my_passwd->pw_uid));
|
||
printf ("My home directory is %s.\n", my_passwd->pw_dir);
|
||
printf ("My default shell is %s.\n", my_passwd->pw_shell);
|
||
|
||
/* Get information about the default group ID. */
|
||
my_group = getgrgid (my_passwd->pw_gid);
|
||
if (!my_group)
|
||
{
|
||
printf ("Couldn't find out about group %d.\n",
|
||
(int) my_passwd->pw_gid);
|
||
exit (EXIT_FAILURE);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print the information. */
|
||
printf ("My default group is %s (%d).\n",
|
||
my_group->gr_name, (int) (my_passwd->pw_gid));
|
||
printf ("The members of this group are:\n");
|
||
members = my_group->gr_mem;
|
||
while (*members)
|
||
{
|
||
printf (" %s\n", *(members));
|
||
members++;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return EXIT_SUCCESS;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
Here is some output from this program:
|
||
|
||
I am Throckmorton Snurd.
|
||
My login name is snurd.
|
||
My uid is 31093.
|
||
My home directory is /home/fsg/snurd.
|
||
My default shell is /bin/sh.
|
||
My default group is guest (12).
|
||
The members of this group are:
|
||
friedman
|
||
tami
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Netgroup Database, Prev: Database Example, Up: Users and Groups
|
||
|
||
30.16 Netgroup Database
|
||
=======================
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Netgroup Data:: Data in the Netgroup database and where
|
||
it comes from.
|
||
* Lookup Netgroup:: How to look for a particular netgroup.
|
||
* Netgroup Membership:: How to test for netgroup membership.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Netgroup Data, Next: Lookup Netgroup, Up: Netgroup Database
|
||
|
||
30.16.1 Netgroup Data
|
||
---------------------
|
||
|
||
Sometimes it is useful to group users according to other criteria (*note
|
||
Group Database::). E.g., it is useful to associate a certain group of
|
||
users with a certain machine. On the other hand grouping of host names
|
||
is not supported so far.
|
||
|
||
In Sun Microsystems’ SunOS appeared a new kind of database, the
|
||
netgroup database. It allows grouping hosts, users, and domains freely,
|
||
giving them individual names. To be more concrete, a netgroup is a list
|
||
of triples consisting of a host name, a user name, and a domain name
|
||
where any of the entries can be a wildcard entry matching all inputs. A
|
||
last possibility is that names of other netgroups can also be given in
|
||
the list specifying a netgroup. So one can construct arbitrary
|
||
hierarchies without loops.
|
||
|
||
Sun’s implementation allows netgroups only for the ‘nis’ or ‘nisplus’
|
||
service, *note Services in the NSS configuration::. The implementation
|
||
in the GNU C Library has no such restriction. An entry in either of the
|
||
input services must have the following form:
|
||
|
||
GROUPNAME ( GROUPNAME | (HOSTNAME,USERNAME,domainname) )+
|
||
|
||
Any of the fields in the triple can be empty which means anything
|
||
matches. While describing the functions we will see that the opposite
|
||
case is useful as well. I.e., there may be entries which will not match
|
||
any input. For entries like this, a name consisting of the single
|
||
character ‘-’ shall be used.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Lookup Netgroup, Next: Netgroup Membership, Prev: Netgroup Data, Up: Netgroup Database
|
||
|
||
30.16.2 Looking up one Netgroup
|
||
-------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The lookup functions for netgroups are a bit different than all other
|
||
system database handling functions. Since a single netgroup can contain
|
||
many entries a two-step process is needed. First a single netgroup is
|
||
selected and then one can iterate over all entries in this netgroup.
|
||
These functions are declared in ‘netdb.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setnetgrent (const char *NETGROUP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:netgrent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
A call to this function initializes the internal state of the
|
||
library to allow following calls of ‘getnetgrent’ to iterate over
|
||
all entries in the netgroup with name NETGROUP.
|
||
|
||
When the call is successful (i.e., when a netgroup with this name
|
||
exists) the return value is ‘1’. When the return value is ‘0’ no
|
||
netgroup of this name is known or some other error occurred.
|
||
|
||
It is important to remember that there is only one single state for
|
||
iterating the netgroups. Even if the programmer uses the
|
||
‘getnetgrent_r’ function the result is not really reentrant since always
|
||
only one single netgroup at a time can be processed. If the program
|
||
needs to process more than one netgroup simultaneously she must protect
|
||
this by using external locking. This problem was introduced in the
|
||
original netgroups implementation in SunOS and since we must stay
|
||
compatible it is not possible to change this.
|
||
|
||
Some other functions also use the netgroups state. Currently these
|
||
are the ‘innetgr’ function and parts of the implementation of the
|
||
‘compat’ service part of the NSS implementation.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getnetgrent (char **HOSTP, char **USERP, char
|
||
**DOMAINP)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:netgrent race:netgrentbuf locale |
|
||
AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem |
|
||
*Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the next unprocessed entry of the currently
|
||
selected netgroup. The string pointers, in which addresses are
|
||
passed in the arguments HOSTP, USERP, and DOMAINP, will contain
|
||
after a successful call pointers to appropriate strings. If the
|
||
string in the next entry is empty the pointer has the value ‘NULL’.
|
||
The returned string pointers are only valid if none of the netgroup
|
||
related functions are called.
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘1’ if the next entry was successfully read. A
|
||
value of ‘0’ means no further entries exist or internal errors
|
||
occurred.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getnetgrent_r (char **HOSTP, char **USERP, char
|
||
**DOMAINP, char *BUFFER, size_t BUFLEN)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:netgrent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function is similar to ‘getnetgrent’ with only one exception:
|
||
the strings the three string pointers HOSTP, USERP, and DOMAINP
|
||
point to, are placed in the buffer of BUFLEN bytes starting at
|
||
BUFFER. This means the returned values are valid even after other
|
||
netgroup related functions are called.
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘1’ if the next entry was successfully read and
|
||
the buffer contains enough room to place the strings in it. ‘0’ is
|
||
returned in case no more entries are found, the buffer is too
|
||
small, or internal errors occurred.
|
||
|
||
This function is a GNU extension. The original implementation in
|
||
the SunOS libc does not provide this function.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void endnetgrent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:netgrent | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin
|
||
heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function frees all buffers which were allocated to process the
|
||
last selected netgroup. As a result all string pointers returned
|
||
by calls to ‘getnetgrent’ are invalid afterwards.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Netgroup Membership, Prev: Lookup Netgroup, Up: Netgroup Database
|
||
|
||
30.16.3 Testing for Netgroup Membership
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
It is often not necessary to scan the whole netgroup since often the
|
||
only interesting question is whether a given entry is part of the
|
||
selected netgroup.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int innetgr (const char *NETGROUP, const char *HOST, const
|
||
char *USER, const char *DOMAIN)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:netgrent locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen
|
||
plugin heap lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock fd mem | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function tests whether the triple specified by the parameters
|
||
HOST, USER, and DOMAIN is part of the netgroup NETGROUP. Using
|
||
this function has the advantage that
|
||
|
||
1. no other netgroup function can use the global netgroup state
|
||
since internal locking is used and
|
||
2. the function is implemented more efficiently than successive
|
||
calls to the other ‘set’/‘get’/‘endnetgrent’ functions.
|
||
|
||
Any of the pointers HOST, USER, or DOMAIN can be ‘NULL’ which means
|
||
any value is accepted in this position. This is also true for the
|
||
name ‘-’ which should not match any other string otherwise.
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘1’ if an entry matching the given triple is
|
||
found in the netgroup. The return value is ‘0’ if the netgroup
|
||
itself is not found, the netgroup does not contain the triple or
|
||
internal errors occurred.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: System Management, Next: System Configuration, Prev: Users and Groups, Up: Top
|
||
|
||
31 System Management
|
||
********************
|
||
|
||
This chapter describes facilities for controlling the system that
|
||
underlies a process (including the operating system and hardware) and
|
||
for getting information about it. Anyone can generally use the
|
||
informational facilities, but usually only a properly privileged process
|
||
can make changes.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Host Identification:: Determining the name of the machine.
|
||
* Platform Type:: Determining operating system and basic
|
||
machine type
|
||
* Filesystem Handling:: Controlling/querying mounts
|
||
|
||
To get information on parameters of the system that are built into
|
||
the system, such as the maximum length of a filename, *note System
|
||
Configuration::.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Host Identification, Next: Platform Type, Up: System Management
|
||
|
||
31.1 Host Identification
|
||
========================
|
||
|
||
This section explains how to identify the particular system on which
|
||
your program is running. First, let’s review the various ways computer
|
||
systems are named, which is a little complicated because of the history
|
||
of the development of the Internet.
|
||
|
||
Every Unix system (also known as a host) has a host name, whether
|
||
it’s connected to a network or not. In its simplest form, as used
|
||
before computer networks were an issue, it’s just a word like ‘chicken’.
|
||
|
||
But any system attached to the Internet or any network like it
|
||
conforms to a more rigorous naming convention as part of the Domain Name
|
||
System (DNS). In the DNS, every host name is composed of two parts:
|
||
|
||
1. hostname
|
||
2. domain name
|
||
|
||
You will note that “hostname” looks a lot like “host name”, but is
|
||
not the same thing, and that people often incorrectly refer to entire
|
||
host names as “domain names.”
|
||
|
||
In the DNS, the full host name is properly called the FQDN (Fully
|
||
Qualified Domain Name) and consists of the hostname, then a period, then
|
||
the domain name. The domain name itself usually has multiple components
|
||
separated by periods. So for example, a system’s hostname may be
|
||
‘chicken’ and its domain name might be ‘ai.mit.edu’, so its FQDN (which
|
||
is its host name) is ‘chicken.ai.mit.edu’.
|
||
|
||
Adding to the confusion, though, is that the DNS is not the only name
|
||
space in which a computer needs to be known. Another name space is the
|
||
NIS (aka YP) name space. For NIS purposes, there is another domain
|
||
name, which is called the NIS domain name or the YP domain name. It
|
||
need not have anything to do with the DNS domain name.
|
||
|
||
Confusing things even more is the fact that in the DNS, it is
|
||
possible for multiple FQDNs to refer to the same system. However, there
|
||
is always exactly one of them that is the true host name, and it is
|
||
called the canonical FQDN.
|
||
|
||
In some contexts, the host name is called a “node name.”
|
||
|
||
For more information on DNS host naming, see *note Host Names::.
|
||
|
||
Prototypes for these functions appear in ‘unistd.h’.
|
||
|
||
The programs ‘hostname’, ‘hostid’, and ‘domainname’ work by calling
|
||
these functions.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int gethostname (char *NAME, size_t SIZE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the host name of the system on which it is
|
||
called, in the array NAME. The SIZE argument specifies the size of
|
||
this array, in bytes. Note that this is _not_ the DNS hostname.
|
||
If the system participates in the DNS, this is the FQDN (see
|
||
above).
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘0’ on success and ‘-1’ on failure. In the GNU
|
||
C Library, ‘gethostname’ fails if SIZE is not large enough; then
|
||
you can try again with a larger array. The following ‘errno’ error
|
||
condition is defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘ENAMETOOLONG’
|
||
The SIZE argument is less than the size of the host name plus
|
||
one.
|
||
|
||
On some systems, there is a symbol for the maximum possible host
|
||
name length: ‘MAXHOSTNAMELEN’. It is defined in ‘sys/param.h’.
|
||
But you can’t count on this to exist, so it is cleaner to handle
|
||
failure and try again.
|
||
|
||
‘gethostname’ stores the beginning of the host name in NAME even if
|
||
the host name won’t entirely fit. For some purposes, a truncated
|
||
host name is good enough. If it is, you can ignore the error code.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sethostname (const char *NAME, size_t LENGTH)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘sethostname’ function sets the host name of the system that
|
||
calls it to NAME, a string with length LENGTH. Only privileged
|
||
processes are permitted to do this.
|
||
|
||
Usually ‘sethostname’ gets called just once, at system boot time.
|
||
Often, the program that calls it sets it to the value it finds in
|
||
the file ‘/etc/hostname’.
|
||
|
||
Be sure to set the host name to the full host name, not just the
|
||
DNS hostname (see above).
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘0’ on success and ‘-1’ on failure. The
|
||
following ‘errno’ error condition is defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
This process cannot set the host name because it is not
|
||
privileged.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int getdomainnname (char *NAME, size_t LENGTH)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘getdomainname’ returns the NIS (aka YP) domain name of the system
|
||
on which it is called. Note that this is not the more popular DNS
|
||
domain name. Get that with ‘gethostname’.
|
||
|
||
The specifics of this function are analogous to ‘gethostname’,
|
||
above.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setdomainname (const char *NAME, size_t LENGTH)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘setdomainname’ sets the NIS (aka YP) domain name of the system on
|
||
which it is called. Note that this is not the more popular DNS
|
||
domain name. Set that with ‘sethostname’.
|
||
|
||
The specifics of this function are analogous to ‘sethostname’,
|
||
above.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: long int gethostid (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe hostid env locale | AS-Unsafe dlopen plugin
|
||
corrupt heap lock | AC-Unsafe lock corrupt mem fd | *Note POSIX
|
||
Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the “host ID” of the machine the program is
|
||
running on. By convention, this is usually the primary Internet IP
|
||
address of that machine, converted to a ‘long int’. However, on
|
||
some systems it is a meaningless but unique number which is
|
||
hard-coded for each machine.
|
||
|
||
This is not widely used. It arose in BSD 4.2, but was dropped in
|
||
BSD 4.4. It is not required by POSIX.
|
||
|
||
The proper way to query the IP address is to use ‘gethostbyname’ on
|
||
the results of ‘gethostname’. For more information on IP
|
||
addresses, *Note Host Addresses::.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int sethostid (long int ID)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe const:hostid | AS-Unsafe | AC-Unsafe
|
||
corrupt fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘sethostid’ function sets the “host ID” of the host machine to
|
||
ID. Only privileged processes are permitted to do this. Usually
|
||
it happens just once, at system boot time.
|
||
|
||
The proper way to establish the primary IP address of a system is
|
||
to configure the IP address resolver to associate that IP address
|
||
with the system’s host name as returned by ‘gethostname’. For
|
||
example, put a record for the system in ‘/etc/hosts’.
|
||
|
||
See ‘gethostid’ above for more information on host ids.
|
||
|
||
The return value is ‘0’ on success and ‘-1’ on failure. The
|
||
following ‘errno’ error conditions are defined for this function:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
This process cannot set the host name because it is not
|
||
privileged.
|
||
|
||
‘ENOSYS’
|
||
The operating system does not support setting the host ID. On
|
||
some systems, the host ID is a meaningless but unique number
|
||
hard-coded for each machine.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Platform Type, Next: Filesystem Handling, Prev: Host Identification, Up: System Management
|
||
|
||
31.2 Platform Type Identification
|
||
=================================
|
||
|
||
You can use the ‘uname’ function to find out some information about the
|
||
type of computer your program is running on. This function and the
|
||
associated data type are declared in the header file ‘sys/utsname.h’.
|
||
|
||
As a bonus, ‘uname’ also gives some information identifying the
|
||
particular system your program is running on. This is the same
|
||
information which you can get with functions targeted to this purpose
|
||
described in *note Host Identification::.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct utsname
|
||
|
||
The ‘utsname’ structure is used to hold information returned by the
|
||
‘uname’ function. It has the following members:
|
||
|
||
‘char sysname[]’
|
||
This is the name of the operating system in use.
|
||
|
||
‘char release[]’
|
||
This is the current release level of the operating system
|
||
implementation.
|
||
|
||
‘char version[]’
|
||
This is the current version level within the release of the
|
||
operating system.
|
||
|
||
‘char machine[]’
|
||
This is a description of the type of hardware that is in use.
|
||
|
||
Some systems provide a mechanism to interrogate the kernel
|
||
directly for this information. On systems without such a
|
||
mechanism, the GNU C Library fills in this field based on the
|
||
configuration name that was specified when building and
|
||
installing the library.
|
||
|
||
GNU uses a three-part name to describe a system configuration;
|
||
the three parts are CPU, MANUFACTURER and SYSTEM-TYPE, and
|
||
they are separated with dashes. Any possible combination of
|
||
three names is potentially meaningful, but most such
|
||
combinations are meaningless in practice and even the
|
||
meaningful ones are not necessarily supported by any
|
||
particular GNU program.
|
||
|
||
Since the value in ‘machine’ is supposed to describe just the
|
||
hardware, it consists of the first two parts of the
|
||
configuration name: ‘CPU-MANUFACTURER’. For example, it might
|
||
be one of these:
|
||
|
||
‘"sparc-sun"’, ‘"i386-ANYTHING"’, ‘"m68k-hp"’,
|
||
‘"m68k-sony"’, ‘"m68k-sun"’, ‘"mips-dec"’
|
||
|
||
‘char nodename[]’
|
||
This is the host name of this particular computer. In the GNU
|
||
C Library, the value is the same as that returned by
|
||
‘gethostname’; see *note Host Identification::.
|
||
|
||
‘gethostname’ is implemented with a call to ‘uname’.
|
||
|
||
‘char domainname[]’
|
||
This is the NIS or YP domain name. It is the same value
|
||
returned by ‘getdomainname’; see *note Host Identification::.
|
||
This element is a relatively recent invention and use of it is
|
||
not as portable as use of the rest of the structure.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int uname (struct utsname *INFO)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘uname’ function fills in the structure pointed to by INFO with
|
||
information about the operating system and host machine. A
|
||
non-negative return value indicates that the data was successfully
|
||
stored.
|
||
|
||
‘-1’ as the return value indicates an error. The only error
|
||
possible is ‘EFAULT’, which we normally don’t mention as it is
|
||
always a possibility.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Filesystem Handling, Prev: Platform Type, Up: System Management
|
||
|
||
31.3 Controlling and Querying Mounts
|
||
====================================
|
||
|
||
All files are in filesystems, and before you can access any file, its
|
||
filesystem must be mounted. Because of Unix’s concept of _Everything is
|
||
a file_, mounting of filesystems is central to doing almost anything.
|
||
This section explains how to find out what filesystems are currently
|
||
mounted and what filesystems are available for mounting, and how to
|
||
change what is mounted.
|
||
|
||
The classic filesystem is the contents of a disk drive. The concept
|
||
is considerably more abstract, though, and lots of things other than
|
||
disk drives can be mounted.
|
||
|
||
Some block devices don’t correspond to traditional devices like disk
|
||
drives. For example, a loop device is a block device whose driver uses
|
||
a regular file in another filesystem as its medium. So if that regular
|
||
file contains appropriate data for a filesystem, you can by mounting the
|
||
loop device essentially mount a regular file.
|
||
|
||
Some filesystems aren’t based on a device of any kind. The “proc”
|
||
filesystem, for example, contains files whose data is made up by the
|
||
filesystem driver on the fly whenever you ask for it. And when you
|
||
write to it, the data you write causes changes in the system. No data
|
||
gets stored.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* Mount Information:: What is or could be mounted?
|
||
* Mount-Unmount-Remount:: Controlling what is mounted and how
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Mount Information, Next: Mount-Unmount-Remount, Up: Filesystem Handling
|
||
|
||
31.3.1 Mount Information
|
||
------------------------
|
||
|
||
For some programs it is desirable and necessary to access information
|
||
about whether a certain filesystem is mounted and, if it is, where, or
|
||
simply to get lists of all the available filesystems. The GNU C Library
|
||
provides some functions to retrieve this information portably.
|
||
|
||
Traditionally Unix systems have a file named ‘/etc/fstab’ which
|
||
describes all possibly mounted filesystems. The ‘mount’ program uses
|
||
this file to mount at startup time of the system all the necessary
|
||
filesystems. The information about all the filesystems actually mounted
|
||
is normally kept in a file named either ‘/var/run/mtab’ or ‘/etc/mtab’.
|
||
Both files share the same syntax and it is crucial that this syntax is
|
||
followed all the time. Therefore it is best to never directly write to
|
||
the files. The functions described in this section can do this and they
|
||
also provide the functionality to convert the external textual
|
||
representation to the internal representation.
|
||
|
||
Note that the ‘fstab’ and ‘mtab’ files are maintained on a system by
|
||
_convention_. It is possible for the files not to exist or not to be
|
||
consistent with what is really mounted or available to mount, if the
|
||
system’s administration policy allows it. But programs that mount and
|
||
unmount filesystems typically maintain and use these files as described
|
||
herein.
|
||
|
||
The filenames given above should never be used directly. The
|
||
portable way to handle these files is to use the macros ‘_PATH_FSTAB’,
|
||
defined in ‘fstab.h’, or ‘_PATH_MNTTAB’, defined in ‘mntent.h’ and
|
||
‘paths.h’, for ‘fstab’; and the macro ‘_PATH_MOUNTED’, also defined in
|
||
‘mntent.h’ and ‘paths.h’, for ‘mtab’. There are also two alternate
|
||
macro names ‘FSTAB’, ‘MNTTAB’, and ‘MOUNTED’ defined but these names are
|
||
deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. The names
|
||
‘_PATH_MNTTAB’ and ‘_PATH_MOUNTED’ should always be used.
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* fstab:: The ‘fstab’ file
|
||
* mtab:: The ‘mtab’ file
|
||
* Other Mount Information:: Other (non-libc) sources of mount information
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: fstab, Next: mtab, Up: Mount Information
|
||
|
||
31.3.1.1 The ‘fstab’ file
|
||
.........................
|
||
|
||
The internal representation for entries of the file is ‘struct fstab’,
|
||
defined in ‘fstab.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct fstab
|
||
|
||
This structure is used with the ‘getfsent’, ‘getfsspec’, and
|
||
‘getfsfile’ functions.
|
||
|
||
‘char *fs_spec’
|
||
This element describes the device from which the filesystem is
|
||
mounted. Normally this is the name of a special device, such
|
||
as a hard disk partition, but it could also be a more or less
|
||
generic string. For "NFS" it would be a hostname and
|
||
directory name combination.
|
||
|
||
Even though the element is not declared ‘const’ it shouldn’t
|
||
be modified. The missing ‘const’ has historic reasons, since
|
||
this function predates ISO C. The same is true for the other
|
||
string elements of this structure.
|
||
|
||
‘char *fs_file’
|
||
This describes the mount point on the local system. I.e.,
|
||
accessing any file in this filesystem has implicitly or
|
||
explicitly this string as a prefix.
|
||
|
||
‘char *fs_vfstype’
|
||
This is the type of the filesystem. Depending on what the
|
||
underlying kernel understands it can be any string.
|
||
|
||
‘char *fs_mntops’
|
||
This is a string containing options passed to the kernel with
|
||
the ‘mount’ call. Again, this can be almost anything. There
|
||
can be more than one option, separated from the others by a
|
||
comma. Each option consists of a name and an optional value
|
||
part, introduced by an ‘=’ character.
|
||
|
||
If the value of this element must be processed it should
|
||
ideally be done using the ‘getsubopt’ function; see *note
|
||
Suboptions::.
|
||
|
||
‘const char *fs_type’
|
||
This name is poorly chosen. This element points to a string
|
||
(possibly in the ‘fs_mntops’ string) which describes the modes
|
||
with which the filesystem is mounted. ‘fstab’ defines five
|
||
macros to describe the possible values:
|
||
|
||
‘FSTAB_RW’
|
||
The filesystem gets mounted with read and write enabled.
|
||
‘FSTAB_RQ’
|
||
The filesystem gets mounted with read and write enabled.
|
||
Write access is restricted by quotas.
|
||
‘FSTAB_RO’
|
||
The filesystem gets mounted read-only.
|
||
‘FSTAB_SW’
|
||
This is not a real filesystem, it is a swap device.
|
||
‘FSTAB_XX’
|
||
This entry from the ‘fstab’ file is totally ignored.
|
||
|
||
Testing for equality with these values must happen using
|
||
‘strcmp’ since these are all strings. Comparing the pointer
|
||
will probably always fail.
|
||
|
||
‘int fs_freq’
|
||
This element describes the dump frequency in days.
|
||
|
||
‘int fs_passno’
|
||
This element describes the pass number on parallel dumps. It
|
||
is closely related to the ‘dump’ utility used on Unix systems.
|
||
|
||
To read the entire content of the of the ‘fstab’ file the GNU C
|
||
Library contains a set of three functions which are designed in the
|
||
usual way.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int setfsent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fsent | AS-Unsafe heap corrupt lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock mem fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function makes sure that the internal read pointer for the
|
||
‘fstab’ file is at the beginning of the file. This is done by
|
||
either opening the file or resetting the read pointer.
|
||
|
||
Since the file handle is internal to the libc this function is not
|
||
thread-safe.
|
||
|
||
This function returns a non-zero value if the operation was
|
||
successful and the ‘getfs*’ functions can be used to read the
|
||
entries of the file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: void endfsent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fsent | AS-Unsafe heap corrupt lock |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt lock mem fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function makes sure that all resources acquired by a prior
|
||
call to ‘setfsent’ (explicitly or implicitly by calling ‘getfsent’)
|
||
are freed.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct fstab * getfsent (void)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fsent locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt heap
|
||
lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the next entry of the ‘fstab’ file. If this
|
||
is the first call to any of the functions handling ‘fstab’ since
|
||
program start or the last call of ‘endfsent’, the file will be
|
||
opened.
|
||
|
||
The function returns a pointer to a variable of type ‘struct
|
||
fstab’. This variable is shared by all threads and therefore this
|
||
function is not thread-safe. If an error occurred ‘getfsent’
|
||
returns a ‘NULL’ pointer.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct fstab * getfsspec (const char *NAME)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fsent locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt heap
|
||
lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the next entry of the ‘fstab’ file which has
|
||
a string equal to NAME pointed to by the ‘fs_spec’ element. Since
|
||
there is normally exactly one entry for each special device it
|
||
makes no sense to call this function more than once for the same
|
||
argument. If this is the first call to any of the functions
|
||
handling ‘fstab’ since program start or the last call of
|
||
‘endfsent’, the file will be opened.
|
||
|
||
The function returns a pointer to a variable of type ‘struct
|
||
fstab’. This variable is shared by all threads and therefore this
|
||
function is not thread-safe. If an error occurred ‘getfsent’
|
||
returns a ‘NULL’ pointer.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct fstab * getfsfile (const char *NAME)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:fsent locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt heap
|
||
lock | AC-Unsafe corrupt lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function returns the next entry of the ‘fstab’ file which has
|
||
a string equal to NAME pointed to by the ‘fs_file’ element. Since
|
||
there is normally exactly one entry for each mount point it makes
|
||
no sense to call this function more than once for the same
|
||
argument. If this is the first call to any of the functions
|
||
handling ‘fstab’ since program start or the last call of
|
||
‘endfsent’, the file will be opened.
|
||
|
||
The function returns a pointer to a variable of type ‘struct
|
||
fstab’. This variable is shared by all threads and therefore this
|
||
function is not thread-safe. If an error occurred ‘getfsent’
|
||
returns a ‘NULL’ pointer.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: mtab, Next: Other Mount Information, Prev: fstab, Up: Mount Information
|
||
|
||
31.3.1.2 The ‘mtab’ file
|
||
........................
|
||
|
||
The following functions and data structure access the ‘mtab’ file.
|
||
|
||
-- Data Type: struct mntent
|
||
|
||
This structure is used with the ‘getmntent’, ‘getmntent_r’,
|
||
‘addmntent’, and ‘hasmntopt’ functions.
|
||
|
||
‘char *mnt_fsname’
|
||
This element contains a pointer to a string describing the
|
||
name of the special device from which the filesystem is
|
||
mounted. It corresponds to the ‘fs_spec’ element in ‘struct
|
||
fstab’.
|
||
|
||
‘char *mnt_dir’
|
||
This element points to a string describing the mount point of
|
||
the filesystem. It corresponds to the ‘fs_file’ element in
|
||
‘struct fstab’.
|
||
|
||
‘char *mnt_type’
|
||
‘mnt_type’ describes the filesystem type and is therefore
|
||
equivalent to ‘fs_vfstype’ in ‘struct fstab’. ‘mntent.h’
|
||
defines a few symbolic names for some of the values this
|
||
string can have. But since the kernel can support arbitrary
|
||
filesystems it does not make much sense to give them symbolic
|
||
names. If one knows the symbol name one also knows the
|
||
filesystem name. Nevertheless here follows the list of the
|
||
symbols provided in ‘mntent.h’.
|
||
|
||
‘MNTTYPE_IGNORE’
|
||
This symbol expands to ‘"ignore"’. The value is
|
||
sometimes used in ‘fstab’ files to make sure entries are
|
||
not used without removing them.
|
||
‘MNTTYPE_NFS’
|
||
Expands to ‘"nfs"’. Using this macro sometimes could
|
||
make sense since it names the default NFS implementation,
|
||
in case both version 2 and 3 are supported.
|
||
‘MNTTYPE_SWAP’
|
||
This symbol expands to ‘"swap"’. It names the special
|
||
‘fstab’ entry which names one of the possibly multiple
|
||
swap partitions.
|
||
|
||
‘char *mnt_opts’
|
||
The element contains a string describing the options used
|
||
while mounting the filesystem. As for the equivalent element
|
||
‘fs_mntops’ of ‘struct fstab’ it is best to use the function
|
||
‘getsubopt’ (*note Suboptions::) to access the parts of this
|
||
string.
|
||
|
||
The ‘mntent.h’ file defines a number of macros with string
|
||
values which correspond to some of the options understood by
|
||
the kernel. There might be many more options which are
|
||
possible so it doesn’t make much sense to rely on these macros
|
||
but to be consistent here is the list:
|
||
|
||
‘MNTOPT_DEFAULTS’
|
||
Expands to ‘"defaults"’. This option should be used
|
||
alone since it indicates all values for the customizable
|
||
values are chosen to be the default.
|
||
‘MNTOPT_RO’
|
||
Expands to ‘"ro"’. See the ‘FSTAB_RO’ value, it means
|
||
the filesystem is mounted read-only.
|
||
‘MNTOPT_RW’
|
||
Expands to ‘"rw"’. See the ‘FSTAB_RW’ value, it means
|
||
the filesystem is mounted with read and write
|
||
permissions.
|
||
‘MNTOPT_SUID’
|
||
Expands to ‘"suid"’. This means that the SUID bit (*note
|
||
How Change Persona::) is respected when a program from
|
||
the filesystem is started.
|
||
‘MNTOPT_NOSUID’
|
||
Expands to ‘"nosuid"’. This is the opposite of
|
||
‘MNTOPT_SUID’, the SUID bit for all files from the
|
||
filesystem is ignored.
|
||
‘MNTOPT_NOAUTO’
|
||
Expands to ‘"noauto"’. At startup time the ‘mount’
|
||
program will ignore this entry if it is started with the
|
||
‘-a’ option to mount all filesystems mentioned in the
|
||
‘fstab’ file.
|
||
|
||
As for the ‘FSTAB_*’ entries introduced above it is important
|
||
to use ‘strcmp’ to check for equality.
|
||
|
||
‘mnt_freq’
|
||
This elements corresponds to ‘fs_freq’ and also specifies the
|
||
frequency in days in which dumps are made.
|
||
|
||
‘mnt_passno’
|
||
This element is equivalent to ‘fs_passno’ with the same
|
||
meaning which is uninteresting for all programs beside ‘dump’.
|
||
|
||
For accessing the ‘mtab’ file there is again a set of three functions
|
||
to access all entries in a row. Unlike the functions to handle ‘fstab’
|
||
these functions do not access a fixed file and there is even a thread
|
||
safe variant of the get function. Besides this the GNU C Library
|
||
contains functions to alter the file and test for specific options.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: FILE * setmntent (const char *FILE, const char *MODE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe heap lock | AC-Unsafe mem fd
|
||
lock | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘setmntent’ function prepares the file named FILE which must be
|
||
in the format of a ‘fstab’ and ‘mtab’ file for the upcoming
|
||
processing through the other functions of the family. The MODE
|
||
parameter can be chosen in the way the OPENTYPE parameter for
|
||
‘fopen’ (*note Opening Streams::) can be chosen. If the file is
|
||
opened for writing the file is also allowed to be empty.
|
||
|
||
If the file was successfully opened ‘setmntent’ returns a file
|
||
handle for future use. Otherwise the return value is ‘NULL’ and
|
||
‘errno’ is set accordingly.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int endmntent (FILE *STREAM)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Unsafe heap lock | AC-Unsafe lock mem
|
||
fd | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function takes for the STREAM parameter a file handle which
|
||
previously was returned from the ‘setmntent’ call. ‘endmntent’
|
||
closes the stream and frees all resources.
|
||
|
||
The return value is 1 unless an error occurred in which case it is
|
||
0.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct mntent * getmntent (FILE *STREAM)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Unsafe race:mntentbuf locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt
|
||
heap init | AC-Unsafe init corrupt lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getmntent’ function takes as the parameter a file handle
|
||
previously returned by a successful call to ‘setmntent’. It
|
||
returns a pointer to a static variable of type ‘struct mntent’
|
||
which is filled with the information from the next entry from the
|
||
file currently read.
|
||
|
||
The file format used prescribes the use of spaces or tab characters
|
||
to separate the fields. This makes it harder to use names
|
||
containing one of these characters (e.g., mount points using
|
||
spaces). Therefore these characters are encoded in the files and
|
||
the ‘getmntent’ function takes care of the decoding while reading
|
||
the entries back in. ‘'\040'’ is used to encode a space character,
|
||
‘'\011'’ to encode a tab character, ‘'\012'’ to encode a newline
|
||
character, and ‘'\\'’ to encode a backslash.
|
||
|
||
If there was an error or the end of the file is reached the return
|
||
value is ‘NULL’.
|
||
|
||
This function is not thread-safe since all calls to this function
|
||
return a pointer to the same static variable. ‘getmntent_r’ should
|
||
be used in situations where multiple threads access the file.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: struct mntent * getmntent_r (FILE *STREAM, struct mntent
|
||
*RESULT, char *BUFFER, int BUFSIZE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt heap | AC-Unsafe
|
||
corrupt lock mem | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘getmntent_r’ function is the reentrant variant of ‘getmntent’.
|
||
It also returns the next entry from the file and returns a pointer.
|
||
The actual variable the values are stored in is not static, though.
|
||
Instead the function stores the values in the variable pointed to
|
||
by the RESULT parameter. Additional information (e.g., the strings
|
||
pointed to by the elements of the result) are kept in the buffer of
|
||
size BUFSIZE pointed to by BUFFER.
|
||
|
||
Escaped characters (space, tab, backslash) are converted back in
|
||
the same way as it happens for ‘getmentent’.
|
||
|
||
The function returns a ‘NULL’ pointer in error cases. Errors could
|
||
be:
|
||
• error while reading the file,
|
||
• end of file reached,
|
||
• BUFSIZE is too small for reading a complete new entry.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int addmntent (FILE *STREAM, const struct mntent *MNT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe race:stream locale | AS-Unsafe corrupt |
|
||
AC-Unsafe corrupt | *Note POSIX Safety Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
The ‘addmntent’ function allows adding a new entry to the file
|
||
previously opened with ‘setmntent’. The new entries are always
|
||
appended. I.e., even if the position of the file descriptor is not
|
||
at the end of the file this function does not overwrite an existing
|
||
entry following the current position.
|
||
|
||
The implication of this is that to remove an entry from a file one
|
||
has to create a new file while leaving out the entry to be removed
|
||
and after closing the file remove the old one and rename the new
|
||
file to the chosen name.
|
||
|
||
This function takes care of spaces and tab characters in the names
|
||
to be written to the file. It converts them and the backslash
|
||
character into the format described in the ‘getmntent’ description
|
||
above.
|
||
|
||
This function returns 0 in case the operation was successful.
|
||
Otherwise the return value is 1 and ‘errno’ is set appropriately.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: char * hasmntopt (const struct mntent *MNT, const char
|
||
*OPT)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
This function can be used to check whether the string pointed to by
|
||
the ‘mnt_opts’ element of the variable pointed to by MNT contains
|
||
the option OPT. If this is true a pointer to the beginning of the
|
||
option in the ‘mnt_opts’ element is returned. If no such option
|
||
exists the function returns ‘NULL’.
|
||
|
||
This function is useful to test whether a specific option is
|
||
present but when all options have to be processed one is better off
|
||
with using the ‘getsubopt’ function to iterate over all options in
|
||
the string.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Other Mount Information, Prev: mtab, Up: Mount Information
|
||
|
||
31.3.1.3 Other (Non-libc) Sources of Mount Information
|
||
......................................................
|
||
|
||
On a system with a Linux kernel and the ‘proc’ filesystem, you can get
|
||
information on currently mounted filesystems from the file ‘mounts’ in
|
||
the ‘proc’ filesystem. Its format is similar to that of the ‘mtab’
|
||
file, but represents what is truly mounted without relying on facilities
|
||
outside the kernel to keep ‘mtab’ up to date.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: Mount-Unmount-Remount, Prev: Mount Information, Up: Filesystem Handling
|
||
|
||
31.3.2 Mount, Unmount, Remount
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
This section describes the functions for mounting, unmounting, and
|
||
remounting filesystems.
|
||
|
||
Only the superuser can mount, unmount, or remount a filesystem.
|
||
|
||
These functions do not access the ‘fstab’ and ‘mtab’ files. You
|
||
should maintain and use these separately. *Note Mount Information::.
|
||
|
||
The symbols in this section are declared in ‘sys/mount.h’.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int mount (const char *SPECIAL_FILE, const char *DIR,
|
||
const char *FSTYPE, unsigned long int OPTIONS, const void
|
||
*DATA)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘mount’ mounts or remounts a filesystem. The two operations are
|
||
quite different and are merged rather unnaturally into this one
|
||
function. The ‘MS_REMOUNT’ option, explained below, determines
|
||
whether ‘mount’ mounts or remounts.
|
||
|
||
For a mount, the filesystem on the block device represented by the
|
||
device special file named SPECIAL_FILE gets mounted over the mount
|
||
point DIR. This means that the directory DIR (along with any files
|
||
in it) is no longer visible; in its place (and still with the name
|
||
DIR) is the root directory of the filesystem on the device.
|
||
|
||
As an exception, if the filesystem type (see below) is one which is
|
||
not based on a device (e.g. “proc”), ‘mount’ instantiates a
|
||
filesystem and mounts it over DIR and ignores SPECIAL_FILE.
|
||
|
||
For a remount, DIR specifies the mount point where the filesystem
|
||
to be remounted is (and remains) mounted and SPECIAL_FILE is
|
||
ignored. Remounting a filesystem means changing the options that
|
||
control operations on the filesystem while it is mounted. It does
|
||
not mean unmounting and mounting again.
|
||
|
||
For a mount, you must identify the type of the filesystem with
|
||
FSTYPE. This type tells the kernel how to access the filesystem
|
||
and can be thought of as the name of a filesystem driver. The
|
||
acceptable values are system dependent. On a system with a Linux
|
||
kernel and the ‘proc’ filesystem, the list of possible values is in
|
||
the file ‘filesystems’ in the ‘proc’ filesystem (e.g. type ‘cat
|
||
/proc/filesystems’ to see the list). With a Linux kernel, the
|
||
types of filesystems that ‘mount’ can mount, and their type names,
|
||
depends on what filesystem drivers are configured into the kernel
|
||
or loaded as loadable kernel modules. An example of a common value
|
||
for FSTYPE is ‘ext2’.
|
||
|
||
For a remount, ‘mount’ ignores FSTYPE.
|
||
|
||
OPTIONS specifies a variety of options that apply until the
|
||
filesystem is unmounted or remounted. The precise meaning of an
|
||
option depends on the filesystem and with some filesystems, an
|
||
option may have no effect at all. Furthermore, for some
|
||
filesystems, some of these options (but never ‘MS_RDONLY’) can be
|
||
overridden for individual file accesses via ‘ioctl’.
|
||
|
||
OPTIONS is a bit string with bit fields defined using the following
|
||
mask and masked value macros:
|
||
|
||
‘MS_MGC_MASK’
|
||
This multibit field contains a magic number. If it does not
|
||
have the value ‘MS_MGC_VAL’, ‘mount’ assumes all the following
|
||
bits are zero and the DATA argument is a null string,
|
||
regardless of their actual values.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_REMOUNT’
|
||
This bit on means to remount the filesystem. Off means to
|
||
mount it.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_RDONLY’
|
||
This bit on specifies that no writing to the filesystem shall
|
||
be allowed while it is mounted. This cannot be overridden by
|
||
‘ioctl’. This option is available on nearly all filesystems.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_NOSUID’
|
||
This bit on specifies that Setuid and Setgid permissions on
|
||
files in the filesystem shall be ignored while it is mounted.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_NOEXEC’
|
||
This bit on specifies that no files in the filesystem shall be
|
||
executed while the filesystem is mounted.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_NODEV’
|
||
This bit on specifies that no device special files in the
|
||
filesystem shall be accessible while the filesystem is
|
||
mounted.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_SYNCHRONOUS’
|
||
This bit on specifies that all writes to the filesystem while
|
||
it is mounted shall be synchronous; i.e., data shall be synced
|
||
before each write completes rather than held in the buffer
|
||
cache.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_MANDLOCK’
|
||
This bit on specifies that mandatory locks on files shall be
|
||
permitted while the filesystem is mounted.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_NOATIME’
|
||
This bit on specifies that access times of files shall not be
|
||
updated when the files are accessed while the filesystem is
|
||
mounted.
|
||
|
||
‘MS_NODIRATIME’
|
||
This bit on specifies that access times of directories shall
|
||
not be updated when the directories are accessed while the
|
||
filesystem in mounted.
|
||
|
||
Any bits not covered by the above masks should be set off;
|
||
otherwise, results are undefined.
|
||
|
||
The meaning of DATA depends on the filesystem type and is
|
||
controlled entirely by the filesystem driver in the kernel.
|
||
|
||
Example:
|
||
|
||
#include <sys/mount.h>
|
||
|
||
mount("/dev/hdb", "/cdrom", "iso9660", MS_MGC_VAL | MS_RDONLY | MS_NOSUID, "");
|
||
|
||
mount("/dev/hda2", "/mnt", "", MS_MGC_VAL | MS_REMOUNT, "");
|
||
|
||
Appropriate arguments for ‘mount’ are conventionally recorded in
|
||
the ‘fstab’ table. *Note Mount Information::.
|
||
|
||
The return value is zero if the mount or remount is successful.
|
||
Otherwise, it is ‘-1’ and ‘errno’ is set appropriately. The values
|
||
of ‘errno’ are filesystem dependent, but here is a general list:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The process is not superuser.
|
||
‘ENODEV’
|
||
The file system type FSTYPE is not known to the kernel.
|
||
‘ENOTBLK’
|
||
The file DEV is not a block device special file.
|
||
‘EBUSY’
|
||
|
||
• The device is already mounted.
|
||
|
||
• The mount point is busy. (E.g. it is some process’
|
||
working directory or has a filesystem mounted on it
|
||
already).
|
||
|
||
• The request is to remount read-only, but there are files
|
||
open for writing.
|
||
|
||
‘EINVAL’
|
||
|
||
• A remount was attempted, but there is no filesystem
|
||
mounted over the specified mount point.
|
||
|
||
• The supposed filesystem has an invalid superblock.
|
||
|
||
‘EACCES’
|
||
|
||
• The filesystem is inherently read-only (possibly due to a
|
||
switch on the device) and the process attempted to mount
|
||
it read/write (by setting the ‘MS_RDONLY’ bit off).
|
||
|
||
• SPECIAL_FILE or DIR is not accessible due to file
|
||
permissions.
|
||
|
||
• SPECIAL_FILE is not accessible because it is in a
|
||
filesystem that is mounted with the ‘MS_NODEV’ option.
|
||
|
||
‘EM_FILE’
|
||
The table of dummy devices is full. ‘mount’ needs to create a
|
||
dummy device (aka “unnamed” device) if the filesystem being
|
||
mounted is not one that uses a device.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int umount2 (const char *FILE, int FLAGS)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘umount2’ unmounts a filesystem.
|
||
|
||
You can identify the filesystem to unmount either by the device
|
||
special file that contains the filesystem or by the mount point.
|
||
The effect is the same. Specify either as the string FILE.
|
||
|
||
FLAGS contains the one-bit field identified by the following mask
|
||
macro:
|
||
|
||
‘MNT_FORCE’
|
||
This bit on means to force the unmounting even if the
|
||
filesystem is busy, by making it unbusy first. If the bit is
|
||
off and the filesystem is busy, ‘umount2’ fails with ‘errno’ =
|
||
‘EBUSY’. Depending on the filesystem, this may override all,
|
||
some, or no busy conditions.
|
||
|
||
All other bits in FLAGS should be set to zero; otherwise, the
|
||
result is undefined.
|
||
|
||
Example:
|
||
|
||
#include <sys/mount.h>
|
||
|
||
umount2("/mnt", MNT_FORCE);
|
||
|
||
umount2("/dev/hdd1", 0);
|
||
|
||
After the filesystem is unmounted, the directory that was the mount
|
||
point is visible, as are any files in it.
|
||
|
||
As part of unmounting, ‘umount2’ syncs the filesystem.
|
||
|
||
If the unmounting is successful, the return value is zero.
|
||
Otherwise, it is ‘-1’ and ‘errno’ is set accordingly:
|
||
|
||
‘EPERM’
|
||
The process is not superuser.
|
||
‘EBUSY’
|
||
The filesystem cannot be unmounted because it is busy. E.g.
|
||
it contains a directory that is some process’s working
|
||
directory or a file that some process has open. With some
|
||
filesystems in some cases, you can avoid this failure with the
|
||
‘MNT_FORCE’ option.
|
||
|
||
‘EINVAL’
|
||
FILE validly refers to a file, but that file is neither a
|
||
mount point nor a device special file of a currently mounted
|
||
filesystem.
|
||
|
||
This function is not available on all systems.
|
||
|
||
-- Function: int umount (const char *FILE)
|
||
|
||
Preliminary: | MT-Safe | AS-Safe | AC-Safe | *Note POSIX Safety
|
||
Concepts::.
|
||
|
||
‘umount’ does the same thing as ‘umount2’ with FLAGS set to zeroes.
|
||
It is more widely available than ‘umount2’ but since it lacks the
|
||
possibility to forcefully unmount a filesystem is deprecated when
|
||
‘umount2’ is also available.
|
||
|
||
|
||
File: libc.info, Node: System Configuration, Next: Cryptographic Functions, Prev: System Management, Up: Top
|
||
|
||
32 System Configuration Parameters
|
||
**********************************
|
||
|
||
The functions and macros listed in this chapter give information about
|
||
configuration parameters of the operating system—for example, capacity
|
||
limits, presence of optional POSIX features, and the default path for
|
||
executable files (*note String Parameters::).
|
||
|
||
* Menu:
|
||
|
||
* General Limits:: Constants and functions that describe
|
||
various process-related limits that have
|
||
one uniform value for any given machine.
|
||
* System Options:: Optional POSIX features.
|
||
* Version Supported:: Version numbers of POSIX.1 and POSIX.2.
|
||
* Sysconf:: Getting specific configuration values
|
||
of general limits and system options.
|
||
* Minimums:: Minimum values for general limits.
|
||
|
||
* Limits for Files:: Size limitations that pertain to individual files.
|
||
These can vary between file systems
|
||
or even from file to file.
|
||
* Options for Files:: Optional features that some files may support.
|
||
* File Minimums:: Minimum values for file limits.
|
||
* Pathconf:: Getting the limit values for a particular file.
|
||
|
||
* Utility Limits:: Capacity limits of some POSIX.2 utility programs.
|
||
* Utility Minimums:: Minimum allowable values of those limits.
|
||
|
||
* String Parameters:: Getting the default search path.
|
||
|